blob: b13b97ced800d0e766cd732949c70376efc90441 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Willy Tarreauc80560b2023-02-14 16:55:17 +01006 2023/02/14
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001018.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
1038.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001239.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
193This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
194streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200198
199HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200200head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200201streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
202other streams.
203
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
205connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
206leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100207start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
208processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
209waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200210
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200211HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100212 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
213 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100214 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100215 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200216 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100217
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100218
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219
2201.2. HTTP request
221-----------------
222
223First, let's consider this HTTP request :
224
225 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100226 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
228 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
229 3 User-agent: my small browser
230 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
231 5 Accept: image/png
232
233
2341.2.1. The Request line
235-----------------------
236
237Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
238
239 - a METHOD : GET
240 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
241 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
242
243All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
244which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
245followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
246is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
247desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
248the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
249
250The URI itself can have several forms :
251
252 - A "relative URI" :
253
254 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
257 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
258
259 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
260
261 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
262
263 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
264 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
265 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
266 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
267 must accept this form too.
268
269 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
270 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
271 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200273 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
274 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
275 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
276 other protocols too.
277
278In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
279mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
280on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
281It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
282specific to the language, framework or application in use.
283
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100284HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100285assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100286
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200287
2881.2.2. The request headers
289--------------------------
290
291The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
292beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
293an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
294Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
295values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
296encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
297the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
298define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100300Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100302"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200303as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
304normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
305representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
306HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200307
308The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
309that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
310is one valid form of empty line.
311
312Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
313headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
314about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
315application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
316
317Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000318 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200319 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
320 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
321 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
322
323
3241.3. HTTP response
325------------------
326
327An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
328messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
329
330 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100331 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200332 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
333 2 Content-length: 350
334 3 Content-Type: text/html
335
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200336As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
337codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
338response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100339continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
340the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
341following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
342sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
343(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
344correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
345such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
346state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400347over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100348if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
349information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200350
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200353------------------------
354
355Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
356
357 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
358 - a status code : 200
359 - a reason : OK
360
361The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100362 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
363 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
364 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
365 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
366 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000368Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100369"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200370found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
371messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
372or "Authentication Required".
373
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100374HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375
376 Code When / reason
377 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
378 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
379 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100381 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
382 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 400 for an invalid or too large request
384 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
385 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100387 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100389 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
390 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400391 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200392 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400393 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100394 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200395 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200396 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200397 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
398 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
399 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
400
401The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4024.2).
403
404
4051.3.2. The response headers
406---------------------------
407
408Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
409the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
410details.
411
412
4132. Configuring HAProxy
414----------------------
415
4162.1. Configuration file format
417------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
419HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
420
421 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700423 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100424 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200425
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100426The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
427a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100428
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100429 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
430
431 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
432
433 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
434 tab characters
435
436 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
437 keyword sequences listed in this document
438
439 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
440 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
441 parts of the configuration, or expressions
442
443 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
444 are supported
445
446 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
447 section
448
449This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
450generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
451figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
452
453First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
454the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
455a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
456word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
457follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
458the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
459the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
460the parts that need to be addressed.
461
462A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
463requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
464extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
465the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
466section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
467section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
468not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
469
470A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
471each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
472a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
473start a new one.
474
475Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
476that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
477applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
478"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
479processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
480ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
481which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
482In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
483of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
484identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
485such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4862, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
487
488 listen foo
489 bind :80
490
491 listen bar
492 bind :81
493
494Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
495spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
496of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
497following configurations are strictly equivalent:
498
499 global#this is the global section
500 daemon#daemonize
501 frontend foo
502 mode http # or tcp
503
504and:
505
506 global
507 daemon
508
509 # this is the public web frontend
510 frontend foo
511 mode http
512
513The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
514new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
515other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
516section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
517section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
518at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
519
520Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
521are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
522editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
523support automatic indent.
524
525In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
526positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
527modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
528anymore, and is not recommended.
529
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200530
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005312.2. Quoting and escaping
532-------------------------
533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
535that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
536possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
537in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
538('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
541very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
542the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
543also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
544delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
545word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
546remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100548If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
549(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
550
551Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
552backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200553
554 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
555 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
556 \\ to use a backslash
557 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
558 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
559
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100560In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
561C-language representation:
562
563 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
564 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
565 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
566 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
567
568Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
569or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
570of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200571
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100572 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200573 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
574 # hash as a comment start
575
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100576Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
577evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
578dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
579backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200580
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100581Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
582character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
583is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
586entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
587name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
588represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
589hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200590
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100591 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
592 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
593 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
594 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
595 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
596 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
597 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
598 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
599 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
600 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
601 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200602
603 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200605 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
606 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
607 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
608 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
609 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
610
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100611There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
612necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
613by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
614they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
615escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
616characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
617case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
618if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
619own quotes.
620
621The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600622quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500623not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100624quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
625
626Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
627arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
628
629 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
631
632Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
633"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
634cannot write:
635
636 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
637
638because we would like the string to cut like this:
639
640 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
641 |---------|----|-|
642 arg1 _/ / /
643 arg2 __________/ /
644 arg3 ______________/
645
646but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
647parenthesis then garbage:
648
649 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
650 |--------|--------|
651 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
652 trailing garbage _________/
653
654The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
655quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
656processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
657this word:
658
659 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
660 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
661 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
662
663So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
664still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
665the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
666the second level:
667
668 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
669 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
670 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
671 |---------||----|-|
672 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
673 arg2=blah ___________/ /
674 arg3=g _______________/
675
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500676Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100677double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
678
679 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
680 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
681 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
682 |---------||----|-|
683 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
684 arg2 ___________/ /
685 arg3 _______________/
686
687When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
688appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
689string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
690thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
691
692 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
693 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
694 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
695 |-------------| |-----||-|
696 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
697 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
698 arg3 ______________________/
699
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400700Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600701that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100702quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
703single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
704level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
705
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600706Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
707if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
708or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
709
710 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
711 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
712 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
713
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100714When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
715double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600716and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100717a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
718a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
719the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
720regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
721around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
722more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200723
724
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007252.3. Environment variables
726--------------------------
727
728HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
729interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
730configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
731optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
732shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200733underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
734list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
735arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100736before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
737use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
738next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
739existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 Example:
742
743 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
744
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100745 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200746
747 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
748
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200749Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
750file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200751
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200752* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
753 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
754
755* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
756 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
757 directory.
758
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100759* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
760 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
761 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
762
763 Example:
764 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
765 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
766
767* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
768 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
769
770* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
771 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
772
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200773* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
774
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500775* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200776 processes, separated by semicolons.
777
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500778* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779 CLI, separated by semicolons.
780
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200781In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
782regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
783only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
784
785* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
786
787* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
788 starting at one.
789
790* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
791 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
792 first section.
793
794These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
795if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
796section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
797"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
798proxies.
799
800This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
801logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
802to name some config objects like servers for example.
803
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200804See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200805
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100806
8072.4. Conditional blocks
808-----------------------
809
810It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
811some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
812ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
813configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
814versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
815preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
816text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
817lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
818switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
819are defined to form conditional blocks:
820
821 - .if <condition>
822 - .elif <condition>
823 - .else
824 - .endif
825
826The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
827as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
828matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
829there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
830only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
831".elif" of a block.
832
833Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
834ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
835as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
836
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200837Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
838See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
839
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200840The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
841expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100843 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
844 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200845 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200846 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530847 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
848 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200849 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
850 from left to right until one returns false
851 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
852 from right to left until one returns true
853
854Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
855operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200856
857The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
858
859 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
860 exists, regardless of its contents
861
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200862 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
863 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
864 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
865
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200866 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
867 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
868
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200869 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
870 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
871 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
872 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
873
874 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
875 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
876 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
877 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
878
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200879Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100880
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200881 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
882 listen mwcli_px
883 bind :1111
884 ...
885 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100886
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200887 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
888 bind :80
889 .endif
890
891 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200892 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200893 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200894 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200895 .endif
896
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200897 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200898 bind :443 ssl crt ...
899 .endif
900
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200901 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
902 profiling.memory on
903 .endif
904
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200905 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
906 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
907 .endif
908
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200909Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100910
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200911 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100912 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
913 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
914 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
915
916Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
917"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
918fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
919provide advice to the user.
920
921Example:
922
923 .if "${A}"
924 .if "${B}"
925 .notice "A=1, B=1"
926 .elif "${C}"
927 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
928 .elif "${D}"
929 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
930 .else
931 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
932 .endif
933 .else
934 .notice "A=0"
935 .endif
936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
938 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
939
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100940
9412.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200942----------------
943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100944Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100945values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
946otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
947numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
948for every keyword. Supported units are :
949
950 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
951 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
952 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
953 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
954 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
955 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
956
957
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009582.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200959-------------
960
961 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
962 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
963 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
964 global
965 daemon
966 maxconn 256
967
968 defaults
969 mode http
970 timeout connect 5000ms
971 timeout client 50000ms
972 timeout server 50000ms
973
974 frontend http-in
975 bind *:80
976 default_backend servers
977
978 backend servers
979 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
980
981
982 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
983 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
984 global
985 daemon
986 maxconn 256
987
988 defaults
989 mode http
990 timeout connect 5000ms
991 timeout client 50000ms
992 timeout server 50000ms
993
994 listen http-in
995 bind *:80
996 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
997
998
999Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1000
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001001 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001002
1003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010043. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001005--------------------
1006
1007Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1008are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1009of them have command-line equivalents.
1010
1011The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1012
1013 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001014 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001015 - 51degrees-cache-size
1016 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001017 - 51degrees-difference
1018 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001019 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1020 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001021 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1022 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001023 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001024 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001025 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001027 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001029 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001030 - description
1031 - deviceatlas-json-file
1032 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001033 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001034 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001035 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001036 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001037 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001039 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001040 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001041 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1042 - h1-case-adjust
1043 - h1-case-adjust-file
1044 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001045 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001046 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1047 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
1048 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1049 - httpclient.ssl.verify
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001050 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001051 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001052 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001053 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001054 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001055 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001056 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001057 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001058 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001059 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001060 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001061 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001062 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001063 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001065 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001066 - presetenv
1067 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001068 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001069 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001070 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001071 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001072 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001073 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001074 - ssl-default-bind-options
1075 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001076 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001077 - ssl-default-server-options
1078 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001079 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001080 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001081 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001082 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001083 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001084 - stats
1085 - strict-limits
1086 - uid
1087 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001088 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001089 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001090 - user
1091 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001092 - wurfl-data-file
1093 - wurfl-information-list
1094 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001095
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001096 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001097 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001098 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001099 - maxcompcpuusage
1100 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001102 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001103 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001104 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001105 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001106 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001107 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001108 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001110 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001111 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001112 - nokqueue
1113 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001114 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001115 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001116 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001117 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001118 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001119 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001120 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001121 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001122 - tune.buffers.limit
1123 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001124 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001125 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001126 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001127 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001128 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001129 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001130 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001131 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001132 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001133 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001134 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001135 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001136 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001137 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001138 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001139 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1140 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001141 - tune.maxaccept
1142 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001143 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001144 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001145 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001146 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001147 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001148 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1149 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001150 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001151 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001152 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001153 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001154 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001155 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001156 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1157 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001158 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001159 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001160 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001161 - tune.sndbuf.client
1162 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001163 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001164 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001165 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1166 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1167 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001168 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1169 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001170 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001171 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1172 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001173 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001174 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001175 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001176 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1177 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1178 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001179 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1180 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001181
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001182 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001183 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001184 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001185 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001186
1187
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011883.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001189------------------------------------
1190
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100119151degrees-data-file <file path>
1192 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1193 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1194
1195 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001196 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001197
119851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1199 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1200 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1201 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1202
1203 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001204 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001205
120651degrees-property-separator <char>
1207 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1208 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1209
1210 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001211 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001212
121351degrees-cache-size <number>
1214 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1215 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1216 By default, this cache is disabled.
1217
1218 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001219 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001220
122151degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1222 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1223 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1224
1225 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001226 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001227
122851degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1229 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1230 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1231
1232 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001233 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001234
123551degrees-drift <number>
1236 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1237
1238 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001239 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001240
124151degrees-difference <number>
1242 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1243
1244 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001245 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001246
124751degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1248 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1249 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1250
1251 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001252 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001253
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001254ca-base <dir>
1255 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001256 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1257 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1258 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001259
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001260chroot <jail dir>
1261 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1262 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1263 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1264 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1265 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001266 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001267
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001268close-spread-time <time>
1269 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1270 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1271 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1272 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1273 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1274 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1275 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1276 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001277 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1278 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1279 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1280 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1281 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001282
1283 Arguments :
1284 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001285 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1286 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001287
1288 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1289 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1290 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1291
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001292 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001293
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001294cluster-secret <secret>
1295 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1296 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1297 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1298 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001299 tokens.
1300
1301 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1302 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1303 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001304
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001305cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1306 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1307 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1308 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1309 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1310 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001311
1312 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1313
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001314 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001315 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1316 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1317 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1318 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1319 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1320 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1321 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
1322 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside
1323 of Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1324 either 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the
1325 processes or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously,
1326 multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will
1327 replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001328
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001329 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1330 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1331 on the machine's word size.
1332
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001333 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1334 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001335 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1336 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001337 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001338 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1339 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001340
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001341 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1342 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1343 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1344 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1345 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001346
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001347 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001348 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001349 # first 4 CPUs
1350
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001351 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1352 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001353 # word size.
1354
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001355 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001356 # and so on.
1357 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1358 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1359 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1360
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001361 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1362 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1363 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1364 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001365
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001366 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1367 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1368 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001369
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001370 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1371 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1372 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1373 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1374 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1375
1376 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1377 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1378 # group may have more than 64 threads.
1379 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39 80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1380 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39 80-119
1381 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79 120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1382 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79 120-159
1383
1384
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001385crt-base <dir>
1386 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001387 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1388 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001389
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001390daemon
1391 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1392 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001393 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1394 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001395
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001396default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001397 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001398 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1399 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1400 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1401 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1402 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1403 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1404 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1405 not start with a slash ('/'):
1406 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1407 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1408
1409 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1410 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1411 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1412 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1413 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1414 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1415 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1416 each of them.
1417
1418 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1419 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1420 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1421 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1422 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1423 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1424 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1425 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1426
1427 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1428 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001429 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001430 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1431 made easily relocatable.
1432
1433 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1434 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1435 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1436 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1437 consistent across all configuration files.
1438
1439 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1440 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1441 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1442 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1443 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1444 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1445 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1446 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1447
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001448description <text>
1449 Add a text that describes the instance.
1450
1451 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1452 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1453 "<" and ">" characters.
1454
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001455deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1456 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001457 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001458
1459deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001460 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001461 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1462
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001463deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001464 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1465 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1466 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001467
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001468deviceatlas-separator <char>
1469 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1470 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1471
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001472expose-experimental-directives
1473 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1474 the config file will be rejected.
1475
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001476external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001477 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1478 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001479 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1480 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1481 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1482 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1483 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001484
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001485fd-hard-limit <number>
1486 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1487 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1488 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1489 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1490 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1491 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1492 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1493 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1494 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1495 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1496 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1497 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1498
1499 global
1500 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1501 fd-hard-limit 50000
1502
1503 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1504
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001505gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001506 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001507 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1508 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001509 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001510 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001511 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001512
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001513grace <time>
1514 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1515
1516 Arguments :
1517 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1518 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1519 soft-stop operation.
1520
1521 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1522 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1523 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1524 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1525 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1526 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1527 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1528 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1529 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1530
1531 Example:
1532
1533 global
1534 grace 10s
1535
1536 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1537 frontend ext-check
1538 bind :9999
1539 monitor-uri /ext-check
1540 monitor fail if { stopping }
1541
1542 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1543 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1544 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1545 SIGUSR1 signal.
1546
1547 Example:
1548
1549 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1550 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1551 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1552 frontend ext-check
1553 bind :9999
1554 monitor-uri /ext-check
1555 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1556
1557 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1558
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001559group <group name>
1560 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1561 See also "gid" and "user".
1562
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001563h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1564 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1565
1566 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1567 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1568 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1569 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1570 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1571 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1572 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1573
1574 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1575 option may be set.
1576
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001577h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1578 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1579 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1580 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1581 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001582 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001583 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1584 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1585 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1586 specified in a proxy.
1587
1588 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1589 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1590 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1591 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1592 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1593 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1594 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1595
1596 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1597 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1598 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1599 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1600 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1601
1602 Example:
1603 global
1604 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1605
1606 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1607 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1608
1609h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1610 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1611 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1612 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1613 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1614 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1615 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1616 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1617 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1618
1619 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1620 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1621 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1622
1623 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1624 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1625
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001626h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1627 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1628 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1629 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1630 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1631 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1632 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1633 the keyword with "no'.
1634
1635hard-stop-after <time>
1636 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1637
1638 Arguments :
1639 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1640 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1641 SIGUSR1 signal.
1642
1643 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1644 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1645 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1646
1647 Example:
1648 global
1649 hard-stop-after 30s
1650
1651 See also: grace
1652
1653httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1654 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1655 to resolve.
1656
1657 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1658 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1659
1660 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1661 configuration error if it fails to load.
1662
1663httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1664 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1665 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1666 option is "ipv6".
1667
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001668httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1669 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1670 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1671 server line.
1672
1673 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1674 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1675 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1676
1677 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1678 configuration error if it fails.
1679
1680httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1681 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1682 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1683
1684 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1685 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1686
1687 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1688 configuration error if it fails.
1689
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001690insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001691 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001692 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1693 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1694 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1695 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1696 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1697 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1698 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001699 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001700 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1701 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1702 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1703 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1704 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1705 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1706 disable it.
1707
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001708insecure-setuid-wanted
1709 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1710 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1711 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1712 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001713 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001714 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001715 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001716 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1717 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001718 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001719 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1720 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1721 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1722 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1723
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001724issuers-chain-path <dir>
1725 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1726 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1727 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001728 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001729 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1730 "issuers-chain-path".
1731 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1732 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1733 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1734 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1735 will share the chain in memory.
1736
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001737localpeer <name>
1738 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1739 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1740 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1741 the configuration parsing.
1742
1743 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1744 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1745
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001746log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001747 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001748 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001749 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001750 configured with "log global".
1751
1752 <address> can be one of:
1753
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001754 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001755 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1756 port).
1757
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001758 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1759 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1760 port).
1761
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001762 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001763 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1764 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001765 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001766
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001767 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1768 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1769 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1770 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1771 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1772 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1773 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1774 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1775 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1776 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001777 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001778 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1779 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1780 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001781 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1782 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001783
1784 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1785 "fd@2", see above.
1786
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001787 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1788 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1789 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1790 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1791 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1792
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001793 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1794 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001795
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001796 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1797 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1798 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1799 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1800 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1801 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1802 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1803 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1804 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1805 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001806 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1807 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001808
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001809 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1810 one of the following :
1811
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001812 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1813 field is stripped. This is the default.
1814 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1815 rfc3164.
1816
1817 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001818 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1819
1820 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1821 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1822
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001823 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1824 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1825 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1826 designed to be used with a local log server.
1827
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001828 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1829 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1830 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1831 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1832 logger consumes.
1833
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001834 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1835 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1836 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1837 used with a local log server.
1838
1839 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1840 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1841 designed to be used with a local log server.
1842
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001843 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1844 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1845 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1846 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1847
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001848 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1849 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1850 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1851 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1852 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1853
1854 <sample_size>
1855 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1856 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1857 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1858 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1859 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1860
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001861 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001862
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001863 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1864 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1865 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1866
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001867 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1868 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1869 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1870 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001871
1872 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001873 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1874 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1875 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1876 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1877 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1878 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001879
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001880 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001881
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001882log-send-hostname [<string>]
1883 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1884 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1885 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1886 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1887 the logs.
1888
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001889log-tag <string>
1890 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1891 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1892 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001893 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001894
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001895lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001896 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1897 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1898 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1899 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1900 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1901 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001902 used multiple times.
1903
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001904 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001905 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05001906 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001907 other files.
1908
1909 local args = table.pack(...)
1910
1911lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001912 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1913 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1914 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1915 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1916 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1917 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1918 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1919 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1920 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1921 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1922 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1923 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1924 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1925 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1926 times.
1927
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001928 See lua-load for usage of args.
1929
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001930lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1931 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1932 variable.
1933 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1934 to "path".
1935
1936 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1937 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1938 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1939 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1940 will be checked earlier.
1941
1942 As an example by specifying the following path:
1943
1944 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1945 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1946
1947 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1948 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1949 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1950 paths if that does not exist either.
1951
1952 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1953 documentation.
1954
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001955master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001956 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1957 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1958 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001959 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001960 or daemon mode.
1961
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001962 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1963 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1964 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1965 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1966 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001967
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001968 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001969
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001970mworker-max-reloads <number>
1971 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001972 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001973 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1974 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1975 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1976
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001977nbthread <number>
1978 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001979 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1980 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1981 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1982 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1983 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1984 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1985 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001986
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01001987no-quic
1988 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
1989 change without deprecation in the future.
1990
1991 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
1992 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
1993 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
1994
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001995numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001996 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1997 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1998 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1999 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2000 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2001 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2002 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2003 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2004 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2005 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002007pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002008 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2009 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2010 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2011 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002012
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002013pp2-never-send-local
2014 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2015 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2016 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2017 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2018 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2019 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2020 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2021 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2022 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2023 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2024 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2025
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002026presetenv <name> <value>
2027 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2028 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2029 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2030 and "unsetenv".
2031
2032resetenv [<name> ...]
2033 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2034 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2035 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2036 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2037 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2038 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2039 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2040 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2041
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002042server-state-base <directory>
2043 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002044 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2045 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002046
2047server-state-file <file>
2048 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2049 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2050 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2051 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2052 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2053 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2054 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2055 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002056 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2057 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002058
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002059set-dumpable
2060 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2061 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2062 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2063 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2064 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2065 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2066 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2067 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2068 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2069 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2070 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2071 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2072 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2073 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2074 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2075 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2076 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2077 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2078
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002079set-var <var-name> <expr>
2080 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2081 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2082 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2083 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2084 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2085 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002086 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002087 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2088 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2089
2090 Example:
2091 global
2092 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2093 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2094 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2095
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002096set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2097 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2098 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2099 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2100 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2101 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2102 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2103 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2104 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2105 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2106 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2107
2108 Example:
2109 global
2110 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2111 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2112
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002113setenv <name> <value>
2114 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2115 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2116 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2117 and "unsetenv".
2118
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002119ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2120 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2121 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002122 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002123 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002124 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2125 information and recommendations see e.g.
2126 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2127 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2128 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2129 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002130
2131ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2133 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2134 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2135 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2136 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002137 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2138 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2139 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002140 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002141
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002142ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2143 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2144 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2145 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2146 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2147 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2148
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002149ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2150 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2151 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2152 keyword to see available options.
2153
2154 Example:
2155 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002156 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002157
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002158ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2159 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2160 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002161 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002162 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002163 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2164 information and recommendations see e.g.
2165 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2166 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2167 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2168 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2169 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002170
2171ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2172 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2173 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2174 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2175 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2176 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002177 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2178 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2179 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2180 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002181
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002182ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2183 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2184 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2185 keyword to see available options.
2186
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002187ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2188 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2189 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2190 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002191 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002192 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002193 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002194 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2195 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2196 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2197 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002198 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2199 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2200 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2201
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002202ssl-propquery <query>
2203 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2204 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2205 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2206 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2207 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2208 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2209 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2210 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2211 was not found.
2212
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002213ssl-provider <name>
2214 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2215 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2216 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2217 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2218 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2219 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002220
2221 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002222 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2223 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2224 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2225 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2226 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002227
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002228 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2229 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2230 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2231 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002232
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002233 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2234
2235ssl-provider-path <path>
2236 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2237 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2238 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2239 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2240 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2241 defined.
2242 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002243
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002244ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2245 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2246 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002247 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002248 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002249 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2250
2251 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002252
2253 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2254 and won't try to remove them.
2255
2256 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2257
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002258ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002259 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002260 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2261 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2262 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002263
2264 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2265 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2266 optimize the startup time.
2267
2268 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2269 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2270 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2271
2272 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002273 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002274
2275 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002276 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2277 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002278
2279 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2280 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2281 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2282 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2283 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002284 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002285
2286 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002287 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002288 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2289 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2290 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2291 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2292 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002293 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002294
2295 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2296
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002297 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002298 a cert bundle.
2299
2300 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2301 separately in several "crt".
2302
2303 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2304 since files are loading separately.
2305
2306 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2307 required to commit them.
2308
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002309 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002310 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002311
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002312 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2313 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2314 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002315
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002316 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2317 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2318 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002319
2320 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002321 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2322 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002323
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002324 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2325 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2326
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002327 The default behavior is "all".
2328
2329 Example:
2330 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2331 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2332 ssl-load-extra-files none
2333
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002334 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2335 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002336
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002337ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2338 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2339 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2340 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2341
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002342ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002343 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002344 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2345 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2346 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2347 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2348 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2349 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002350 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002351
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002352stats maxconn <connections>
2353 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2354 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2355
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002356stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2357 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2358 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2359 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002360 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002361 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002362
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002363 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2364 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2365 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002366
2367stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2368 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2369 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002370 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002371
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002372strict-limits
2373 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2374 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2375 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2376 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2377 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002378
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002379thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2380 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2381 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2382 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2383 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2384 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2385 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2386 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2387 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2388 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2389
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002390thread-groups <number>
2391 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2392 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002393 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2394 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2395 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2396 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2397 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002398
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002399trace <args...>
2400 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2401 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2402 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2403 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2404 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2405 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2406 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2407 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2408 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2409 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2410 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2411 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2412 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2413 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2414 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2415 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2416 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2417
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002418uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002419 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002420 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2421 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2422 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2423
2424ulimit-n <number>
2425 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2426 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002427 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2428 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002429
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002430 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2431 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2432 manually specify this value.
2433
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002434 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2435
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002436unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2437 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2438
2439 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2440 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2441 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2442 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2443 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002444 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002445 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2446 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2447 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2448 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2449
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002450unsetenv [<name> ...]
2451 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2452 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2453 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2454 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2455 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2456 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2457 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2458
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002459user <user name>
2460 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2461 See also "uid" and "group".
2462
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002463node <name>
2464 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2465
2466 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2467 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2468 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2469 traffic.
2470
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002471wurfl-cache-size <size>
2472 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2473 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2474 - "0" : no cache is used.
2475 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002476
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002477 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2478 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002479
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002480wurfl-data-file <file path>
2481 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2482 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2483
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002484 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002485 with USE_WURFL=1.
2486
2487wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2488 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2489 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2490 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2491
2492 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2493
2494 Valid WURFL properties are:
2495 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2496
2497 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2498 device.
2499
2500 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2501 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2502
2503 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2504 particular web request.
2505
2506 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2507 used Libwurfl API version.
2508
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002509 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2510 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2511
2512 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2513 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2514
2515 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2516
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002517 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002518 with USE_WURFL=1.
2519
2520wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2521 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2522 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2523
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002524 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002525 with USE_WURFL=1.
2526
2527wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2528 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2529 thus before the chroot.
2530
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002531 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002532 with USE_WURFL=1.
2533
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025343.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002535-----------------------
2536
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002537busy-polling
2538 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2539 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2540 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2541 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2542 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2543 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2544 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2545 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2546 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2547 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2548 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2549 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2550 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2551 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2552 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2553 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2554 "poll" pollers.
2555
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002556 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2557 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2558 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2559
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002560max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002561 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002562 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2563 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2564 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2565 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2566 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2567 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2568 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2569
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002570maxcompcpuusage <number>
2571 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2572 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2573 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2574 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2575 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2576 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2577 and from introducing high latencies.
2578
2579maxcomprate <number>
2580 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2581 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2582 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2583 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2584 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2585 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2586 default value.
2587
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002588maxconn <number>
2589 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2590 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2591 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002592 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2593 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2594 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2595 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002596 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2597 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2598 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2599 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2600 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002601 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2602
2603 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002604
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002605maxconnrate <number>
2606 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2607 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2608 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2609 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2610 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2611 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2612 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2613 fairness.
2614
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002615maxpipes <number>
2616 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2617 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2618 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2619 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2620 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2621 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2622
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002623maxsessrate <number>
2624 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2625 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2626 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2627 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2628 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2629 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2630 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2631 fairness.
2632
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002633maxsslconn <number>
2634 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2635 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2636 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2637 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2638 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2639 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2640 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002641 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2642 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2643 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2644 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002645 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002646 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2647 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002648
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002649maxsslrate <number>
2650 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2651 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2652 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2653 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2654 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2655 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2656 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2657 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2658 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2659 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2660
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002661maxzlibmem <number>
2662 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2663 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2664 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002665 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2666 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2667 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2668
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002669no-memory-trimming
2670 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2671 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2672 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2673 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2674 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2675 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2676 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2677 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2678 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2679 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2680 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2681 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2682 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2683 not suffer from such a problem.
2684
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002685noepoll
2686 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2687 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002688 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002689
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002690noevports
2691 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2692 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2693 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2694 also "nopoll".
2695
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002696nogetaddrinfo
2697 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2698 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2699
2700nokqueue
2701 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2702 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2703 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2704
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002705nopoll
2706 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2707 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002708 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002709 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2710 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002711
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002712noreuseport
2713 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2714 command line argument "-dR".
2715
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002716nosplice
2717 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002718 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002719 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002720 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002721 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2722 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2723 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2724 "option splice-response".
2725
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002726profiling.memory { on | off }
2727 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2728 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2729 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2730 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2731 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2732 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2733 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2734 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2735 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2736
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002737profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2738 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2739 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2740 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2741 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002742 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002743 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2744 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2745 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2746 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2747
2748 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2749 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2750 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2751 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2752 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002753 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2754 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2755 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2756 CLI.
2757
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002758spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002759 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2760 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2761 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2762 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2763 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2764 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002765
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002766ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002767 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002768 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002769 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002770 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002771 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2772 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2773 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002774 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2775 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002776 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2777 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2778 openssl configuration file uses:
2779 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2780
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002781ssl-mode-async
2782 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002783 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002784 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2785 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002786 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002787 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002788 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002789
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002790tune.buffers.limit <number>
2791 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2792 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2793 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2794 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2795 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002796 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002797 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2798 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2799 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2800 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2801 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2802 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2803 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2804 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002805 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002806
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002807tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2808 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2809 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2810 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002811 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002812
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002813tune.bufsize <number>
2814 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2815 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2816 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2817 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2818 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2819 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2820 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002821 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2822 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002823 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002824 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002825 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002826 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2827 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002828
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002829tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2830 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2831 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2832 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2833 this value. The default value is 1.
2834
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002835tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2836 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2837 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2838 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2839 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2840 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2841 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2842 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2843 appear on a line before this directive.
2844
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002845tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002846 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
2847 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
2848 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
2849 failures are handled gracefully.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002850
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002851tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2852 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2853 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2854 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2855 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2856 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2857
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002858tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2859 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2860 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2861 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2862 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2863 change it.
2864
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002865tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2866 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002867 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002868 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Glenn Strauss0012f892022-06-04 22:11:50 -04002869 The default value is 65536, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002870 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2871 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2872 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2873 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2874
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002875tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2876 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2877 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2878 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2879 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2880 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002881 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002882 recommended not to change this value.
2883
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002884tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002885 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002886 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002887 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002888 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2889 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2890 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2891 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2892
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002893tune.http.cookielen <number>
2894 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2895 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2896 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2897 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2898 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2899 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2900 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2901 to change this value.
2902
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002903tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002904 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2905 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002906 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002907 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002908 configuration directives too.
2909 The default value is 1024.
2910
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002911tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2912 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2913 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2914 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2915 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2916 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2917 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002918 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2919 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2920 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002921
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002922tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2923 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2924 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2925 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2926 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2927 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2928 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002929 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2930 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2931 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2932 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2933 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002934
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002935tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002936 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002937 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2938 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2939 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2940 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002941 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002942 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002943 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002944 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2945
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002946tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2947 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2948 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2949 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2950 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2951 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2952 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2953 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2954 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2955 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2956
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002957tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2958 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002959 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002960 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2961 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002962 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002963 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2964 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2965
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002966tune.lua.maxmem
2967 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2968 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2969 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2970 memory.
2971
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002972tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2973 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002974 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2975 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002976 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002977
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002978tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2979 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2980 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2981 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002982 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002983
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002984tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2985 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2986 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2987 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2988 check servers.
2989
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002990tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002991 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2992 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002993 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2994 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2995 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2996 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2997 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2998 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2999 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3000 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3001 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003002
3003tune.maxpollevents <number>
3004 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3005 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3006 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3007 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3008 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3009
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003010tune.maxrewrite <number>
3011 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3012 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3013 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3014 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3015 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3016 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3017 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3018 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3019 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3020 bufsize.
3021
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003022tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3023 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3024 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3025 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3026 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3027 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3028 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3029 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3030 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3031 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3032 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3033 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3034 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3035 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3036 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3037
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003038tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3039 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3040 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3041 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3042 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3043 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3044 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3045 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3046 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3047 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003048 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3049 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003050 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3051 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3052 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3053 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3054 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3055 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3056 setting this parameter to 0.
3057
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003058tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3059 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3060 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3061 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3062 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3063 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3064 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3065 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3066
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003067tune.pipesize <number>
3068 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3069 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3070 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3071 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3072 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3073 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3074
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003075tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3076 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003077 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003078 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3079 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3080 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3081 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003082 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003083
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003084tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3085 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003086 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003087 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3088 default is 20.
3089
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003090tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003091 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3092 change without deprecation in the future.
3093
3094 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3095 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3096 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3097 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003098 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003099
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003100tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
3101 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3102 change without deprecation in the future.
3103
3104 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3105 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3106 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3107 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3108 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3109 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3110 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3111
3112 The default value is 30000.
3113
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003114tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
3115 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3116 change without deprecation in the future.
3117
3118 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3119 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3120 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3121 requests.
3122
3123 The default value is 100.
3124
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003125tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
3126 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3127 change without deprecation in the future.
3128
3129 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3130 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3131
3132 The default value is 10.
3133
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003134tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
3135 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3136 change without deprecation in the future.
3137
3138 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003139 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3140 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003141 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3142 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003143 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3144 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003145
3146 The default value is 100.
3147
3148 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3149 information about QUIC retry.
3150
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003151tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
3152 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
3153 change without deprecation in the future.
3154
3155 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3156 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3157 own socket.
3158
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003159 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3160 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003161 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
3162 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC
3163 connections. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
3164 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
3165 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003166
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003167 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3168 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3169 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003170 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003171 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003172
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003173tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3174tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3175 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3176 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3177 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003178 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003179 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003180 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3181 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3182
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003183tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003184 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003185 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3186 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3187 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3188 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3189
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003190tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003191 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003192 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3193 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3194 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3195 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3196 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3197 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3198 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003199
3200tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3201 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003202 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003203 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3204 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3205 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3206 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3207 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3208 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3209 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003210
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003211tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3212tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3213 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3214 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3215 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003216 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003217 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003218 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3219 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3220 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3221 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003222 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003223
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003224tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003225 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003226 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3227 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3228 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3229 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3230 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3231 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3232 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3233 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3234 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003235 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3236 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003237
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003238tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3239tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3240 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3241 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3242 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3243 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3244
3245tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3246 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3247 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3248 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3249 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3250 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3251 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3252 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3253 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3254 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3255 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3256 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3257 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3258
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003259tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003260 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003261 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3262 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3263 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3264 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3265 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3266
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003267tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3268 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3269 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3270 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3271 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3272
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003273tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3274 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3275 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3276 performances. This is disabled by default.
3277
3278 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3279 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3280
3281 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3282
3283 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3284
3285 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3286
3287 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3288 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3289 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3290
3291 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3292 converted.
3293
3294 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3295 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3296 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3297 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3298 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3299 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3300 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003301 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3302 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003303
3304 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3305
3306 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3307 only need this line:
3308
3309 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3310
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003311tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3312 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003313 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003314 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3315 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3316 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3317 being used for too long.
3318
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003319tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003320 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3321 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3322 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3323 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3324 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3325 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3326 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3327 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3328 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3329 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3330 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3331 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3332 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003333
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003334tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3335 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3336 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3337 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3338 1000 entries.
3339
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003340tune.stick-counters <number>
3341 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3342 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
3343 "http-request" rules. The defaut value is set at build time by the macro
3344 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3345 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3346 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3347 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3348 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3349 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3350 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3351 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3352 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3353 entirely disable stick-counters).
3354
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003355tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003356tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003357tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3358tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3359tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003360 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3361 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3362 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3363 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3364 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3365 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3366 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3367 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003368
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003369 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3370 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3371 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3372 all available space is consumed.
3373 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3374 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3375 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003376
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003377tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3378 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003379 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003380 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003381 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003382 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3383
3384tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3385 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3386 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003387 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3388 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003389
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033903.3. Debugging
3391--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003392
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003393anonkey <key>
3394 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3395 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3396 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Erwan Le Goasb0c05012022-09-14 17:51:55 +02003397 from the CLI command "set global-key". See also command line argument "-dC"
3398 in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003399
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003400quick-exit
3401 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3402 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3403 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3404 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3405 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3406 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3407 do so by developers.
3408
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003409quiet
3410 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3411 line argument "-q".
3412
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003413zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003414 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003415 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3416 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3417 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3418 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3419 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3420
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003421
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010034223.4. Userlists
3423--------------
3424It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3425http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3426it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3427
3428userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003429 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003430 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3431
3432group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003433 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003434 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3435 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3436
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003437user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3438 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003439 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3440 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003441 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3442 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3443 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3444 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003445
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003446 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3447 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3448 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3449 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3450 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3451 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3452 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003453 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003454 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003455
3456 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003457 userlist L1
3458 group G1 users tiger,scott
3459 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003460
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003461 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3462 user scott insecure-password elgato
3463 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003464
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003465 userlist L2
3466 group G1
3467 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003468
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003469 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3470 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3471 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003472
3473 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003474
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003475
34763.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003477----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003478It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003479several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003480instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003481values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3482type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3483values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3484active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3485switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3486present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3487watch it.
3488
3489Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3490known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3491the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3492process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3493during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3494tables.
3495
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003496Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3497that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3498each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003499
3500peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003501 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003502 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3503
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003504bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3505 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3506 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3507
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003508disabled
3509 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3510 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3511 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3512
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003513default-bind [param*]
3514 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3515
3516default-server [param*]
3517 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3518
3519 Arguments:
3520 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3521 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003522 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3523 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3524 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3525 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003526
3527 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3528
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003529enabled
3530 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3531 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003532
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003533log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003534 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3535 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3536 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3537 more details.
3538
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003539peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003540 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3541 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003542 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003543 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003544 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3545 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3546 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003547
3548 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3549 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3550
3551 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003552 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3553 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3554 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003555
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003556 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3557 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003558
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003559 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3560 "server" keyword explanation below).
3561
3562server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003563 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003564 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3565 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3566 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3567 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003568
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003569 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3570 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3571 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3572 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3573 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003574
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003575 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003576 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003577 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003578 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3579 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3580 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003581
3582 backend mybackend
3583 mode tcp
3584 balance roundrobin
3585 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3586 stick on src
3587
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003588 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3589 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003590
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003591 Example:
3592 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003593 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3594 default-server ssl verify none
3595 server haproxy1 #local peer
3596 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3597 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003598
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003599shards <shards>
3600
3601 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3602 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3603 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3604 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3605 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003606
3607table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3608 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3609
3610 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3611 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003612 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003613 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3614 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3615 "stick-table" keyword).
3616
3617 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3618 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3619 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3620 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3621 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3622 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3623 of the stick-table name as follows:
3624
3625 peers mypeers
3626 peer A ...
3627 peer B ...
3628 table t1 ...
3629
3630 frontend fe1
3631 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3632
3633 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3634 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3635
3636 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3637 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3638 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3639 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3640 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3641 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3642 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3643
3644 peers mypeers
3645 peer A ...
3646 peer B ...
3647 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3648
3649 backend t1
3650 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3651
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003652 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003653 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3654 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3655
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090036563.6. Mailers
3657------------
3658It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3659If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3660in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3661
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003662mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003663 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3664 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3665
3666mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3667 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3668
3669 Example:
3670 mailers mymailers
3671 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3672 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3673
3674 backend mybackend
3675 mode tcp
3676 balance roundrobin
3677
3678 email-alert mailers mymailers
3679 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3680 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3681
3682 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3683 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3684
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003685timeout mail <time>
3686 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3687 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3688 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3689 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3690
3691 Example:
3692 mailers mymailers
3693 timeout mail 20s
3694 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003695
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020036963.7. Programs
3697-------------
3698In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3699master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3700managed the same way as the workers.
3701
3702During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3703sequence as a worker:
3704
3705 - the master is re-executed
3706 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3707 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3708 instance of the program
3709
3710During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3711
3712program <name>
3713 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3714 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3715 the management guide).
3716
3717command <command> [arguments*]
3718 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3719 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3720 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3721 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3722
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003723user <user name>
3724 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3725 See also "group".
3726
3727group <group name>
3728 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3729 See also "user".
3730
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003731option start-on-reload
3732no option start-on-reload
3733 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3734 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3735 program section.
3736
3737
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010037383.8. HTTP-errors
3739----------------
3740
3741It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3742imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3743several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3744
3745http-errors <name>
3746 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3747 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3748
3749errorfile <code> <file>
3750 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3751
3752 Arguments :
3753 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003754 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003755 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003756
3757 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3758 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3759 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3760 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3761 before any chroot is performed.
3762
3763 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3764
3765 Example:
3766 http-errors website-1
3767 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3768 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3769 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3770
3771 http-errors website-2
3772 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3773 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3774 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3775
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020037763.9. Rings
3777----------
3778
3779It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3780servers or traces.
3781
3782ring <ringname>
3783 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3784
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003785backing-file <path>
3786 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
3787 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
3788 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
3789 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
3790 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
3791 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
3792 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
3793
3794 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
3795 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
3796 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
3797 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02003798 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
3799 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
3800 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
3801 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
3802 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
3803 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
3804 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
3805 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
3806 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
3807 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
3808 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
3809 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02003810
3811 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
3812 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
3813 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
3814 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
3815 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
3816 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
3817 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
3818
3819 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
3820 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
3821 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
3822
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003823description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003824 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003825 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3826
3827format <format>
3828 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3829
3830 Arguments:
3831 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3832 one of the following :
3833
3834 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3835 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3836 designed to be used with a local log server.
3837
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003838 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3839 field is stripped. This is the default.
3840 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3841 rfc3164.
3842
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003843 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3844 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3845 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3846 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3847 is the default.
3848
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003849 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003850 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3851
3852 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3853 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3854
3855 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3856 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3857 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3858 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3859 logger consumes.
3860
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003861 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3862 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3863 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3864 with a local log server.
3865
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003866 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3867 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3868 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3869 used with a local log server.
3870
3871maxlen <length>
3872 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3873 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3874 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3875
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003876server <name> <address> [param*]
3877 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3878 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3879 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3880 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3881 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3882 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3883 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3884 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3885 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003886 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3887 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003888
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003889size <size>
3890 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3891 set to BUFSIZE.
3892
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003893timeout connect <timeout>
3894 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3895
3896 Arguments :
3897 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3898 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3899 as explained at the top of this document.
3900
3901timeout server <timeout>
3902 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3903
3904 Arguments :
3905 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3906 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3907 as explained at the top of this document.
3908
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003909 Example:
3910 global
3911 log ring@myring local7
3912
3913 ring myring
3914 description "My local buffer"
3915 format rfc3164
3916 maxlen 1200
3917 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003918 timeout connect 5s
3919 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003920 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003921
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020039223.10. Log forwarding
3923-------------------
3924
3925It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003926HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003927
3928log-forward <name>
3929 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3930
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003931backlog <conns>
3932 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3933 on connections accept.
3934
3935bind <addr> [param*]
3936 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003937 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3938 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3939 syslog protocol over TCP.
3940 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003941 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3942
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003943dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003944 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3945 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3946 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3947 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003948 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003949
3950log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003951log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003952 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3953 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3954 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003955 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003956 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3957 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3958 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003959 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003960
3961 Example:
3962 global
3963 log stderr format iso local7
3964
3965 ring myring
3966 description "My local buffer"
3967 format rfc5424
3968 maxlen 1200
3969 size 32764
3970 timeout connect 5s
3971 timeout server 10s
3972 # syslog tcp server
3973 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3974
3975 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003976 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3977 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003978 # all messages on stderr
3979 log global
3980 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3981 log ring@myring local0
3982 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3983 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3984 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3985 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3986 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003987
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003988maxconn <conns>
3989 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3990 10 is the default.
3991
3992timeout client <timeout>
3993 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020039954. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003996----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003997
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003998Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003999 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4000 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4001 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4002 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004003
4004A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4005connections.
4006
4007A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4008to forward incoming connections.
4009
4010A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4011parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4012
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004013A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4014ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4015sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4016the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4017explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4018from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4019"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4020for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4021to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4022optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4023are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4024any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4025names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4026that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4027duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004028names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4029is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4030implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4031encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4032adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004033
4034Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4035settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4036of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4037profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4038timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4039
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004040All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4041'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4042case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4043
4044Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4045logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4046proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4047However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4048name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4049
4050Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4051and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004052bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004053protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4054modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4055arbitrary criteria.
4056
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004057In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4058a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004059the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004060
4061 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4062 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4063 between responses and new requests.
4064
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004065 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4066 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4067 client-facing connection remains open.
4068
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004069 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4070 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004071
4072The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4073frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4074following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004075weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004076
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004077 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004078
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004079 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4080 ----+-----+-----+----
4081 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4082 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004083 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4084 ----+-----+-----+----
4085 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004086
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004087It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004088only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4089within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004090as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004091content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004092and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4093possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004094
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004095There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004096first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004097processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004098second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004099protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4100is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4101new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004102to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004103process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4104already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4105HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4106evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4107one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4108
4109There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4110performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4111tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4112preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4113analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4114HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4115header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4116mitigate this drawback.
4117
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004118There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004119method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4120set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4121in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4122is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4123to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4124above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4125to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4126"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4127frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4128frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4129as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4130upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4131on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4132the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4133upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4134frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4135remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020041374.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4138--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004140The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4141limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4142they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4143limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004144marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004145option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004146and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4147with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004148specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4149sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4150anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004151
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004152
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004153 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4154------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004155acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004156backlog X X X -
4157balance X - X X
4158bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004159capture cookie - X X -
4160capture request header - X X -
4161capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004162clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4163clitcpka-idle X X X -
4164clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004165compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004166cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004167declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004168default-server X - X X
4169default_backend X X X -
4170description - X X X
4171disabled X X X X
4172dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004173email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004174email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004175email-alert mailers X X X X
4176email-alert myhostname X X X X
4177email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004178enabled X X X X
4179errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004180errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004181errorloc X X X X
4182errorloc302 X X X X
4183-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4184errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004185error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004186force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004187filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004188fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004189hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004190http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004191http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004192http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004193http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004194http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004195http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004196http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004197http-check set-var X - X X
4198http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004199http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004200http-request X (!) X X X
4201http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004202http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004203http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004204id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004205ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004206load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004207log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004208log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004209log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004210log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004211max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004212maxconn X X X -
4213mode X X X X
4214monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004215monitor-uri X X X -
4216option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4217option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4218option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4219option allbackups (*) X - X X
4220option checkcache (*) X - X X
4221option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4222option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004223option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004224option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4225option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004226-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4227option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004228option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004229option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4230option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004231option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004232option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004233option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004234option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004235option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004236option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004237option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4238option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4239option httpchk X - X X
4240option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004241option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004242option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004243option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004244option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004245option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004246option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4247option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4248option logasap (*) X X X -
4249option mysql-check X - X X
4250option nolinger (*) X X X X
4251option originalto X X X X
4252option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004253option pgsql-check X - X X
4254option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004255option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004256option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004257option smtpchk X - X X
4258option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4259option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4260option splice-request (*) X X X X
4261option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004262option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004263option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4264option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4265-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004266option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004267option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4268option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4269option tcpka X X X X
4270option tcplog X X X X
4271option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004272option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004273external-check command X - X X
4274external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004275persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4276rate-limit sessions X X X -
4277redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004278-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004279retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004280retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004281server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004282server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004283server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004284source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004285srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4286srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4287srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004288stats admin - X X X
4289stats auth X X X X
4290stats enable X X X X
4291stats hide-version X X X X
4292stats http-request - X X X
4293stats realm X X X X
4294stats refresh X X X X
4295stats scope X X X X
4296stats show-desc X X X X
4297stats show-legends X X X X
4298stats show-node X X X X
4299stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004300-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4301stick match - - X X
4302stick on - - X X
4303stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004304stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004305stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004306tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004307tcp-check connect X - X X
4308tcp-check expect X - X X
4309tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004310tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004311tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004312tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004313tcp-check set-var X - X X
4314tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004315tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4316tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4317tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4318tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4319tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4320tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004321timeout check X - X X
4322timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004323timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004324timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004325timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4326timeout http-request X X X X
4327timeout queue X - X X
4328timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004329timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004330timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004331timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004332transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004333unique-id-format X X X -
4334unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004335use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004336use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004337use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004338------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4339 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004340
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020043424.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4343---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004344
4345This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4346
4347
4348acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4349 Declare or complete an access list.
4350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004351 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4352
4353 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4354 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4355 using it.
4356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004357 Example:
4358 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4359 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4360 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004362 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004363
4364
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004365backlog <conns>
4366 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4368 yes | yes | yes | no
4369 Arguments :
4370 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4371 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004372 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004373
4374 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4375 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4376 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4377 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4378 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4379 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4380 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4381 backlog parameter.
4382
4383 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4384 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4385 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4386
4387 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4388
4389
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004390balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004391balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004392 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4393 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4394 yes | no | yes | yes
4395 Arguments :
4396 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4397 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4398 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4399 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4400
4401 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4402 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4403 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4404 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004405 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004406 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004407 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4408 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4409 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4410 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4411 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4412 it, so that you don't worry.
4413
4414 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4415 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4416 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4417 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4418 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4419 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4420 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4421 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004422
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004423 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4424 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4425 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4426 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4427 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4428 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4429 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004430 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4431 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4432 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004433
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004434 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004435 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004436 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4437 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004438 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004439 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4440 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4441 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4442 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4443 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004444 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4445 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4446 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4447 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4448 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4449 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004450
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004451 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4452 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4453 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4454 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4455 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4456 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4457 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4458 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4459 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4460 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4461 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4462 changed using "hash-type".
4463
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004464 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4465 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4466 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4467 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4468 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4469 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4470 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4471 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004472 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004473 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004474 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4475 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004476 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004477
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004478 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4479 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4480 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4481 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4482 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4483 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4484 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4485 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4486 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4487 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4488 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4489 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004491 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004492 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4493 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4494 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4495 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4496 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4497 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4498 URIs start with a leading "/".
4499
4500 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4501 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4502 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4503 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4504
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004505 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4506 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4507 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004508 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4509 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004510
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004511 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004512 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4513
4514 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004515 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4516 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004517 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4518 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4519 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4520 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004521 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004522 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4523 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004524
4525 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4526 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4527 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4528 server will receive the request.
4529
4530 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4531 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4532 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4533 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4534 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004535 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4536 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004537 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4538 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004539
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004540 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4541 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4542 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4543 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4544 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004545
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004546 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004547 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4548 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4549 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4550
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004551 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4552 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004553 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4554 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004555
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004556 random
4557 random(<draws>)
4558 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004559 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4560 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4561 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4562 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004563 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4564 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4565 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4566 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4567 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4568 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4569 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4570 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4571 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4572 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4573 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4574 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4575 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4576 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4577 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4578 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4579 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4580 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4581 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4582 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004583
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004584 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004585 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004586 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4587 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004588 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004589 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4590 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4591 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004592 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004593 used instead.
4594
4595 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4596 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4597 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004598 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004599
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004600 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4601 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004602 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4603 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004604
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004605 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004606 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4607 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004608
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004609 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4610 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4611 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004612
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004613 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004614 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004615 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4616 NTLM relies on.
4617
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004618 Examples :
4619 balance roundrobin
4620 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004621 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004622 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4623 balance hdr(host)
4624 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004625 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4626 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4627 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004628
4629 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4630 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4631
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004632 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004633 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4634 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4635 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004636 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004637
4638 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4639 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4640 defaults to 16 kB.
4641
4642 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4643 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4644
4645 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4646 Round Robin.
4647
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004648 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004649 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4650 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4651 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4652
4653 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4654
4655 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004656 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004657 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4658 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4659 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004660
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004661 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004662
4663
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004664bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4665bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004666 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4667 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4668 no | yes | yes | no
4669 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004670 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4671 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4672 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4673 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004674 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
4675 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
4676 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
4677 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
4678 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004679 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4680 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4681 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4682 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4683 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4684 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004685 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004686 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4687 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004688 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004689 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4690 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004691 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004692 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4693 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004694 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004695 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004696 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4697 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4698 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004699 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4700 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4701 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4702 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004703 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01004704 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
4705 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.conn-owner" on
4706 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
4707 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
4708 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
4709 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
4710 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004711 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01004712 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
4713 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004714
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004715 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4716 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4717 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004718
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004719 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4720 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004721 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4722 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4723 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004724 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4725 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4726 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4727 the range.
4728
4729 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4730 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4731 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4732 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4733 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4734 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4735 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004736 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004737 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004738
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004739 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004740 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004741 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4742 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4743 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4744 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4745 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4746 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4747
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004748 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4749 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4750 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4751 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004752
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004753 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4754 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4755 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4756 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4757 in a frontend.
4758
4759 Example :
4760 listen http_proxy
4761 bind :80,:443
4762 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004763 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004764
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004765 listen http_https_proxy
4766 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004767 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004768
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004769 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4770 bind ipv6@:80
4771 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4772 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4773
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004774 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004775 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004776
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004777 listen h3_quic_proxy
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01004778 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt alpn h3
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02004779
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004780 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4781 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4782 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4783 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4784 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4785
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004786 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004787 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004788
4789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004790capture cookie <name> len <length>
4791 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4793 no | yes | yes | no
4794 Arguments :
4795 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4796 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4797 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4798 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004799 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004800
4801 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4802 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4803 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4804 right if it exceeds <length>.
4805
4806 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4807 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4808 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4809 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4810
4811 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4812 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4813 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4814
4815 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4816 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4817 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004818 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4819 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4820 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004821
4822 Example:
4823 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4824
4825 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004826 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004827
4828
4829capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004830 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4832 no | yes | yes | no
4833 Arguments :
4834 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004835 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004836 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4837 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4838 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4839
4840 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4841 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4842 it exceeds <length>.
4843
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004844 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004845 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4846 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004847 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4848 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4849 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4850 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004851 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004852 environments to find where the request came from.
4853
4854 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4855 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4856 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4857 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004858
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004859 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4860 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4861 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4862 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4863 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004864
4865 Example:
4866 capture request header Host len 15
4867 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004868 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004869
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004870 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004871 about logging.
4872
4873
4874capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004875 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004876 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4877 no | yes | yes | no
4878 Arguments :
4879 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004880 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004881 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4882 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4883 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4884
4885 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4886 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4887 it exceeds <length>.
4888
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004889 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004890 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4891 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4892 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004893 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4894 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4895 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4896 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004897
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004898 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4899 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4900 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4901 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4902 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004903
4904 Example:
4905 capture response header Content-length len 9
4906 capture response header Location len 15
4907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004908 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004909 about logging.
4910
4911
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004912clitcpka-cnt <count>
4913 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4914 the connection on the client side.
4915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4916 yes | yes | yes | no
4917 Arguments :
4918 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4919
4920 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4921 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004922 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4923 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004924
4925 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4926
4927
4928clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4929 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4930 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4931 client side.
4932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4933 yes | yes | yes | no
4934 Arguments :
4935 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4936 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4937 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4938 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4939
4940 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4941 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004942 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4943 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004944
4945 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4946
4947
4948clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4949 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4951 yes | yes | yes | no
4952 Arguments :
4953 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4954 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4955 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4956 document.
4957
4958 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4959 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004960 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4961 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004962
4963 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4964
4965
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004966compression algo <algorithm> ...
4967compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004968 Enable HTTP compression.
4969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4970 yes | yes | yes | yes
4971 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004972 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4973 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004974
4975 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004976 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4977 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4978 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004979
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004980 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004981 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004982
4983 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4984 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4985 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4986 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4987 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004988 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004989
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004990 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4991 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4992 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4993 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4994 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4995 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4996 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004997 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004998
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004999 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005000 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005001 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005002 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005003 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005004 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005005 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005006
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005007 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005008 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5009 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005010 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005011 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005012 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5013 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5014 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5015 "multipart"
5016 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5017 header
5018 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5019 and later
5020 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5021 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005022 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005023
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005024 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005025
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005026 Examples :
5027 compression algo gzip
5028 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005029
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005030 See also : "compression offload"
5031
5032compression offload
5033 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5034 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5035 no | yes | yes | yes
5036
5037 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5038 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5039 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5040 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5041 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5042 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5043 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5044 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5045 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5046 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5047 then be used for such scenarios.
5048
5049 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5050 option is ignored.
5051
5052 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005053
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005054cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005055 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5056 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005057 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005058 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5060 yes | no | yes | yes
5061 Arguments :
5062 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5063 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5064 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5065 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5066 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5067 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005068 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005069 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5070 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5071
5072 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005073 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005074 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5075 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5076 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5077 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005078 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5079 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005080 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005081 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5082 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005083
5084 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005085 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005086
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005087 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005088 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005089 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005090 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005091 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5092 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5093 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5094 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5095 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5096 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5097 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005098
5099 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5100 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5101 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5102 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5103 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5104 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5105 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5106 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5107 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005108 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005109 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5110 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5111 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005112
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005113 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5114 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5115 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005116 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5117 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5118 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5119 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005120 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5121 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5122 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005123
5124 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5125 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5126 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5127 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5128 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5129 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5130 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5131 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5132 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5133
5134 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5135 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5136 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5137 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5138 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5139 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5140 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5141 persistence cookie in the cache.
5142 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5143
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005144 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5145 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005146 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005147 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5148 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005149 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005150 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5151 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5152 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5153 they logout.
5154
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005155 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005156 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5157 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5158 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5159
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005160 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005161 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5162 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5163 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5164 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5165 this attribute.
5166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005167 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005168 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005169 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5170 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5171 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5172 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5173 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5174 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005175
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005176 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5177 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5178 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5179 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5180 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5181 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5182 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5183 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005184 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005185 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5186 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5187 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5188 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5189 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5190 the site.
5191
5192 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5193 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5194 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5195 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5196 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5197 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5198 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5199 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5200 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5201 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5202 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5203 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5204 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005205 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005206 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5207 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5208
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005209 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5210 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5211 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5212 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5213 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5214 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5215
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005216 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005217 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5218 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5219 repeated.
5220
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005221 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5222 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5223 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5224 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005225
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005226 Examples :
5227 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5228 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5229 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005230 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005231
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005232 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005233
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005234
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005235declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5236 Declares a capture slot.
5237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5238 no | yes | yes | no
5239 Arguments:
5240 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5241
5242 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5243 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5244 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5245 for use in the response.
5246
5247 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005248 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005249 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5250
5251
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005252default-server [param*]
5253 Change default options for a server in a backend
5254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5255 yes | no | yes | yes
5256 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005257 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5258 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5259 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5260 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005261
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005262 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005263 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5264
5265 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005266
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005267
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005268default_backend <backend>
5269 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5271 yes | yes | yes | no
5272 Arguments :
5273 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5274
5275 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5276 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5277 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5278 will catch all undetermined requests.
5279
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005280 Example :
5281
5282 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5283 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5284 default_backend dynamic
5285
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005286 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005287
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005288
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005289description <string>
5290 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5292 no | yes | yes | yes
5293 Arguments : string
5294
5295 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5296 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5297 it describes.
5298 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5299
5300
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005301disabled
5302 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5303 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5304 yes | yes | yes | yes
5305 Arguments : none
5306
5307 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5308 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5309 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5310 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5311 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5312 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5313 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5314
5315 See also : "enabled"
5316
5317
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005318dispatch <address>:<port>
5319 Set a default server address
5320 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5321 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005322 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005323
5324 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5325 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5326 during start-up.
5327
5328 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5329 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5330 possible with normal servers.
5331
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005332 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005333 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5334 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5335 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5336 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5337
5338 See also : "server"
5339
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005340
5341dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5342 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5343 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5344 yes | no | yes | yes
5345 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5346
5347 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005348 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005349 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5350 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005351 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005352 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005353
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005354enabled
5355 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5357 yes | yes | yes | yes
5358 Arguments : none
5359
5360 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5361 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5362
5363 See also : "disabled"
5364
5365
5366errorfile <code> <file>
5367 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5369 yes | yes | yes | yes
5370 Arguments :
5371 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005372 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005373 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005374
5375 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005376 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005377 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005378 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5379 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005380
5381 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5382 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5383 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5384
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005385 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5386
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005387 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5388 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5389 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5390 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5391 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5392 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5393 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5394 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5395 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005396
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005397 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5398 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5399 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005400 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005401 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5402
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005403 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005404
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005405 Example :
5406 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005407 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005408 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5409 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5410
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005411
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005412errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5413 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5414 section.
5415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5416 yes | yes | yes | yes
5417 Arguments :
5418 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5419
5420 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005421 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005422 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5423 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005424
5425 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5426 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5427 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5428 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5429 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005430 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005431 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5432
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005433 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5434 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005435
5436 Example :
5437 errorfiles generic
5438 errorfiles site-1 403 404
5439
5440
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005441errorloc <code> <url>
5442errorloc302 <code> <url>
5443 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5445 yes | yes | yes | yes
5446 Arguments :
5447 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005448 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005449 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005450
5451 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5452 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5453 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5454 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005455 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005456
5457 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5458 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5459 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5460
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005461 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5462
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005463 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5464 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5465 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5466 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005467 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005468 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5469 request.
5470
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005471 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005472
5473
5474errorloc303 <code> <url>
5475 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5477 yes | yes | yes | yes
5478 Arguments :
5479 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005480 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005481 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005482
5483 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5484 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5485 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5486 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005487 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005488
5489 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5490 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5491 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5492
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005493 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5494
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005495 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5496 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5497 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5498 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005499 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005500
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005501 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005502
5503
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005504email-alert from <emailaddr>
5505 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005506 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005507 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5508 yes | yes | yes | yes
5509
5510 Arguments :
5511
5512 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5513
5514 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5515 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5516
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005517 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005518 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5519 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005520
5521
5522email-alert level <level>
5523 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5524 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5526 yes | yes | yes | yes
5527
5528 Arguments :
5529
5530 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5531 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5532 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5533
5534 By default level is alert
5535
5536 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5537 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5538 for the proxy.
5539
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005540 Alerts are sent when :
5541
5542 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5543 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5544 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5545 is notice or lower
5546 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5547 and a health check status update occurs
5548
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005549 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5550 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005551 section 3.6 about mailers.
5552
5553
5554email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5555 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5556 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5557 yes | yes | yes | yes
5558
5559 Arguments :
5560
5561 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5562
5563 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5564 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5565
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005566 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5567 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005568
5569
5570email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5571 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5572 mailers.
5573 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5574 yes | yes | yes | yes
5575
5576 Arguments :
5577
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005578 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005579
5580 By default the systems hostname is used.
5581
5582 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5583 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5584 for the proxy.
5585
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005586 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5587 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005588
5589
5590email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005591 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005592 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5593 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5594 yes | yes | yes | yes
5595
5596 Arguments :
5597
5598 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5599
5600 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5601 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5602
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005603 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005604 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5605
5606
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005607error-log-format <string>
5608 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5610 yes | yes | yes | no
5611
5612 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5613 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5614 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5615 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005616 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5617
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005618 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5619 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5620 string in depth.
5621
5622 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5623 directives.
5624
5625
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005626force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5627 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5628 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005629 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005630
5631 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5632 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5633 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5634 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5635 marked down for maintenance operations.
5636
5637 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5638 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5639 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5640 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5641 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5642 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5643 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5644 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5645 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5646
5647 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5648 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5649 is used.
5650
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005651 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005652 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005653
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005654
5655filter <name> [param*]
5656 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5657 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5658 no | yes | yes | yes
5659 Arguments :
5660 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5661 referenced in section 9.
5662
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005663 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005664 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005665 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5666 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005667
5668 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5669 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5670
5671 Example:
5672 listen
5673 bind *:80
5674
5675 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5676 filter compression
5677 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5678
5679 compression algo gzip
5680 compression offload
5681
5682 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5683
5684 See also : section 9.
5685
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005686
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005687fullconn <conns>
5688 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5690 yes | no | yes | yes
5691 Arguments :
5692 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5693 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5694
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005695 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005696 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005697 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005698 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5699 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5700 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5701 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5702 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005703 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005704
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005705 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005706 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005707 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5708 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5709 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005710
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005711 Example :
5712 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5713 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5714 # connections.
5715 backend dynamic
5716 fullconn 10000
5717 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5718 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5719
5720 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5721
5722
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005723hash-balance-factor <factor>
5724 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5726 yes | no | no | yes
5727 Arguments :
5728 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5729 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005730 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005731
5732 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5733 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5734 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5735 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5736 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5737 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5738 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5739
5740 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5741 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5742 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5743 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5744 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5745
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005746 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5747 consistent hashing mechanism.
5748
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005749 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5750
5751
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005752hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005753 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5754 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5755 yes | no | yes | yes
5756 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005757 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5758 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005759
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005760 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5761 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5762 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5763 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5764 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5765 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5766 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5767 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5768 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5769 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005770
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005771 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5772 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5773 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5774 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5775 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5776 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5777 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5778 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5779 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5780 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5781 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5782 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5783 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005784 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5785 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005786
5787 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5788
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005789 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005790 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5791 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5792 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005793 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5794 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5795 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005796
5797 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5798 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005799 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5800 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5801 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5802 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5803
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005804 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005805 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5806 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5807 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5808 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5809 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5810 parameter.
5811
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005812 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5813 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5814 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5815 used on strings.
5816
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005817 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5818
5819 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5820 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5821 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5822 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5823 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5824 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5825 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5826 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5827 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5828 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5829 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5830 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005831
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005832 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5833 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5834 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005835
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005836 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005837
5838
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005839http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5840 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5841 ones).
5842
5843 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005844 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005845
5846 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5847 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5848 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5849 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5850 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5851 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5852
5853 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5854 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5855 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5856
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005857 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5858 supported:
5859 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5860 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005861 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005862 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005863 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005864 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005865 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5866 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005867 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
5868 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
5869 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
5870 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5871 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005872 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005873 - set-log-level <level>
5874 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005875 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005876 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5877 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005878 - strict-mode { on | off }
5879 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5880
5881 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005882
5883 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5884 instance.
5885
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005886 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5887 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5888 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5889 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5890 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5891 a defaults section defining such rules.
5892
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005893 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5894 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5895 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5896
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005897 Example:
5898 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5899 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5900 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5901
5902http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5903
5904 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005905 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5906 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005907
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01005908http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5909
5910 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5911 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
5912
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005913http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5914
5915 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5916 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5917 complete description.
5918
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005919http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5920
5921 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
5922 del-acl" for a complete description.
5923
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005924http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005925
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005926 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5927 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005928
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005929http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5930
5931 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
5932 del-map" for a complete description.
5933
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005934http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5935 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5936
5937 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5938
5939 Example:
5940 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5941
5942 # applied to:
5943 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5944
5945 # outputs:
5946 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5947
5948 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5949
5950http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5951 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5952
5953 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5954
5955 Example:
5956 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5957
5958 # applied to:
5959 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5960
5961 # outputs:
5962 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5963
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01005964http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5965http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5966http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5967
5968 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
5969 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
5970 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
5971 description.
5972
5973http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5974 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5975http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5976 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5977
5978 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
5979 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
5980 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
5981
5982http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5983
5984 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
5985 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
5986
5987http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5988
5989 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
5990 set-map" for a complete description.
5991
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005992http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5993
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005994 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5995 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5996 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5997 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005998
5999http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6000 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6001
6002 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006003 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006004 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006005
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006006http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6007http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006008
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006009 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6010 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6011 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006012
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006013http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006014
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006015 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6016 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006017
6018http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6019
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006020 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6021 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006022
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006023
6024http-check comment <string>
6025 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6026 it fails.
6027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6028 yes | no | yes | yes
6029
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006030 Arguments :
6031 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6032 rule fails.
6033
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006034 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6035 user-friendly error reporting.
6036
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006037 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006038 "http-check expect".
6039
6040
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006041http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6042 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006043 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006044 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6045 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6046 yes | no | yes | yes
6047
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006048 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006049 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6050
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006051 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006052 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006053
6054 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6055 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6056 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6057 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6058
6059 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6060
6061 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6062
6063 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6064
6065 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6066
6067 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6068
6069 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6070 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6071 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6072 is used.
6073
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006074 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6075 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6076 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6077 haproxy -vv.
6078
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006079 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6080
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006081 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6082 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6083 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6084 different ports or with different servers.
6085
6086 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6087 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6088 the port with a "http-check connect".
6089
6090 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6091 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6092 do.
6093
6094 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6095 unset-var or comment rules.
6096
6097 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006098 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6099 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6100 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6101 option httpchk
6102
6103 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006104 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006105 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006106 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006107 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006108 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006109
6110 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6111
6112 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006113
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006114
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006115http-check disable-on-404
6116 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6117 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006118 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006119 Arguments : none
6120
6121 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6122 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6123 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6124 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6125 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6126 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6127 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6128 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006129 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6130 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006131 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6132 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6133 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006134
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006135 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006136
6137
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006138http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006139 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6140 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6141 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006142 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006144 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006145
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006146 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006147 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6148
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006149 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6150 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6151 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6152 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6153 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6154 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6155 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6156 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6157 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6158 result is always conclusive.
6159
6160 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6161 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6162 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006163 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6164 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006165 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6166 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006167 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6168 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6169 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006170
6171 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6172 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006173 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6174 supported :
6175 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6176 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006177 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6178 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6179 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6180 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6181 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006182
6183 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6184 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006185 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6186 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6187 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6188 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006189 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6190
6191 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6192 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6193 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6194 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6195
6196 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6197 informational message reported in logs if an error
6198 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6199 log-format string.
6200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006201 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006202 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6203 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006204 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6205 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6206 details on the supported keywords.
6207
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006208 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6209 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6210 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6211 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006212
6213 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6214 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6215 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6216 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6217 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6218
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006219 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6220 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6221 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6222 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6223 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6224 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6225 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006226
6227 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006228 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006229 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6230 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6231 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6232 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6233
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006234 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6235 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006236 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6237 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6238 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6239 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6240 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6241 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6242 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6243 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006244 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6245 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6246 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6247 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6248 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6249 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6250 insensitive on the header names.
6251
6252 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6253 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6254 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6255 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6256 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6257 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006258
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006259 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006260 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006261 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6262 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6263 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6264 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6265 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006266 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006267 trace).
6268
6269 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006270 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006271 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6272 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6273 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6274 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6275 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006276 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006277
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006278 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6279 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6280 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6281 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6282 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6283 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6284
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006285 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006286 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006287 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6288 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6289 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6290 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6291 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6292 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6293
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006294 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6295 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6296 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6297 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6298 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006299
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006300 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6301 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6302
6303 Examples :
6304 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006305 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006306
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006307 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6308 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6309
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006310 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006311 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006312
6313 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006314 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006315
6316 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006317 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006318
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006319 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006320 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006321
6322
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006323http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006324 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6325 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006326 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6327 health checks.
6328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6329 yes | no | yes | yes
6330 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006331 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6332
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006333 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6334 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6335 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6336 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6337 to invent non-standard ones.
6338
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006339 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6340 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6341 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6342 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6343
6344 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6345 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6346 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6347 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006348
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006349 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006350 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006351 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006352 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6353 to add it.
6354
6355 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6356 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6357 to the log-format rules.
6358
6359 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6360 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6361 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006362
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006363 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6364 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6365 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6366 request.
6367
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006368 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6369 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6370 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006371 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6372 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6373 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6374 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006375 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006376
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006377 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006378 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6379 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006380
6381 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6382 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6383 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6384 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6385 configured request authority.
6386
6387 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6388 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006389
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006390 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006391
6392
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006393http-check send-state
6394 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6396 yes | no | yes | yes
6397 Arguments : none
6398
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006399 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006400 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006401 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6402 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6403 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006404
6405 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6406 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6407 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6408 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6409 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006410 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6411 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6412 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6413
6414 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6415 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6416 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6417
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006418 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6419 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6420 checked in multiple backends.
6421
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006422 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006423 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6424
6425 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6426 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6427 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6428 one fails.
6429
6430 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6431 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6432 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6433
6434 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6435 server's queue.
6436
6437 Example of a header received by the application server :
6438 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6439 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6440
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006441 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6442 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006443
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006444
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006445http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6446http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006447 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006448 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6449 yes | no | yes | yes
6450
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006451 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006452 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6453 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6454 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6455 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6456 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6457 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6458 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6459 and '-'.
6460
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006461 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6462 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006463 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006464 conditions.
6465
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006466 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6467
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006468 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6469 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6470
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006471 Examples :
6472 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006473 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006474
6475
6476http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006477 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006478 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6479 yes | no | yes | yes
6480
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006481 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006482 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6483 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6484 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6485 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6486 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6487 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6488 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6489 and '-'.
6490
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006491 Examples :
6492 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006493
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006494
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006495http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6496 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6497 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6498 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6499 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6501 yes | yes | yes | yes
6502 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006503 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006504 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006505 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006506 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006507
6508 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6509 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6510 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6511 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6512
6513 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6514 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6515 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6516 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6517
6518 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6519 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6520 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6521 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6522 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6523 chroot is performed.
6524
6525 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6526 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6527 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6528 considered.
6529
6530 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6531 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6532 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6533 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6534 considered as a raw string.
6535
6536 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6537 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6538 "content-type".
6539
6540 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6541 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6542 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6543 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6544 evaluated as a log-format string.
6545
6546 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6547 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6548 argument to "content-type".
6549
6550 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6551 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6552 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6553 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6554
6555 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6556 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6557 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6558 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6559 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6560 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6561 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6562 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6563
6564 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6565 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6566 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6567
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006568 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6569 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6570 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6571 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6572 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6573
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006574 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6575 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6576
6577
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006578http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006579 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6580
6581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006582 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006583
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006584 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6585 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6586 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6587 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6588 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006589
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006590 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6591 supported:
6592 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6593 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6594 - allow
6595 - auth [realm <realm>]
6596 - cache-use <name>
6597 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6598 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6599 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6600 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6601 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6602 - disable-l7-retry
6603 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6604 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6605 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6606 - redirect <rule>
6607 - reject
6608 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6609 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6610 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6611 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6612 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6613 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6614 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6615 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6616 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6617 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6618 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01006619 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006620 - set-dst <expr>
6621 - set-dst-port <expr>
6622 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6623 - set-log-level <level>
6624 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6625 - set-mark <mark>
6626 - set-method <fmt>
6627 - set-nice <nice>
6628 - set-path <fmt>
6629 - set-pathq <fmt>
6630 - set-priority-class <expr>
6631 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6632 - set-query <fmt>
6633 - set-src <expr>
6634 - set-src-port <expr>
6635 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6636 - set-tos <tos>
6637 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006638 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6639 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006640 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01006641 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006642 - strict-mode { on | off }
6643 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6644 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6645 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6646 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6647 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6648 - use-service <service-name>
6649 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6650 - wait-for-handshake
6651 - cache-use <name>
6652
6653 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006655 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006656
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006657 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6658 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6659 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6660 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6661 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6662 a defaults section defining such rules.
6663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006664 Example:
6665 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6666 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6667 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006669 http-request allow if nagios
6670 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6671 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6672 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006673
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006674 Example:
6675 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6676 acl add path /addacl
6677 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006678
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006679 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006680
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006681 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6682 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006683
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006684 Example:
6685 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6686 acl setmap path /setmap
6687 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006688
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006689 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006690
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006691 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6692 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006694 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6695 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006696
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006697http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006698
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006699 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6700 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6701 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6702 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6703 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6704 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6705 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6706 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006707
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006708http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006709
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006710 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6711 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6712 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6713 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6714 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6715 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6716 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6717 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006718
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006719http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006721 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006722 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006724http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006726 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6727 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6728 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6729 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6730 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006731
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006732 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6733 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6734 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6735 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6736 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6737 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6738 instead.
6739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006740 Example:
6741 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6742 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006743
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006744http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006745
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006746 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006748http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6749 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006751 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6752 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6753 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6754 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6755 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6756 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6757 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6758 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6759 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006761 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6762 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6763 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006764 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6765
6766 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6767 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6768 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6769 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006771http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006772
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006773 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6774 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6775 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6776 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6777 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6778 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006779
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006780http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006781
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006782 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6783 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6784 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6785 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6786 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006788http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006790 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6791 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6792 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6793 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6794 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6795 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006796
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006797http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6798http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6799 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6800 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6801 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6802 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006803
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006804 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6805 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6806 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006807 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006808 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6809 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6810 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006811 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006812 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006813
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006814http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6815 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6816 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6817 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6818
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006819http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6820 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006821
6822 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6823 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6824 pointed by <resolvers>.
6825 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6826 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6827 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6828 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6829 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6830 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6831 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6832 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6833 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6834 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006835 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6836 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006837
6838 Example:
6839 resolvers mydns
6840 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6841 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6842 timeout retry 1s
6843 hold valid 10s
6844 hold nx 3s
6845 hold other 3s
6846 hold obsolete 0s
6847 accepted_payload_size 8192
6848
6849 frontend fe
6850 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02006851 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006852 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6853
6854 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6855 # which mean DNS resolution error
6856 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6857
6858 default_backend be
6859
6860 backend b_503
6861 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6862 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6863 # 503 error page to end users
6864
6865 backend be
6866 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6867 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6868 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6869 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6870 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6871
6872 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6873 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6874
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006875http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6876
6877 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6878 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6879 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6880 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006881 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6882 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006883
6884 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6885
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006886http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006887http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006888http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006889http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006890http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006891http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006892http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006893http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6894http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006895
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006896 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6897
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006898 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006899 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6900 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6901 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6902 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006903
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006904 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6905 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6906 the supported backend.
6907
6908 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6909 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6910 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6911 number of segments in the path.
6912
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006913 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6914 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6915 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6916 when improperly combined.
6917
6918 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6919 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6920 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6921 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6922 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6923
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006924 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006925
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006926 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6927
6928 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6929 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6930
6931 Example:
6932 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6933
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006934 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6935
6936 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6937 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6938
6939 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6940 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6941
6942 Example:
6943 - /#foo -> /
6944
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006945 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6946 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006947
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006948 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6949 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6950
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006951 Example:
6952 - /. -> /
6953 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6954 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6955 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006956
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006957 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6958 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6959
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006960 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006961 their preceding segment.
6962
6963 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6964 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6965
6966 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6967 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006968
6969 Example:
6970 - /foo/../ -> /
6971 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6972 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6973 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006974 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006975 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006976 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006977
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006978 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6979 removed as well:
6980
6981 Example:
6982 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6983 - /bar/../../ -> /
6984
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006985 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6986 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006987
6988 Example:
6989 - // -> /
6990 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6991
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006992 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6993 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6994
6995 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6996 ".", "_", and "~".
6997
6998 Example:
6999 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7000 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7001 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7002 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7003
7004 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7005 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7006
7007 Example:
7008 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7009 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7010
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007011 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007012 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007013
7014 Example:
7015 - /%6f -> /%6F
7016 - /%zz -> /%zz
7017
7018 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7019 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7020
7021 Example:
7022 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7023
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007024 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007025 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7026 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7027
7028 Example:
7029 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7030 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7031 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007033http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007034
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007035 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7036 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7037 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7038 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7039 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007040
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007041http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007043 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7044 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7045 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7046 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007048http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7049 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007050
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007051 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007052 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7053 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7054 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7055 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7056 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007057
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007058 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7059 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7060 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7061 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7062 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007063
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007064 Example:
7065 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7066
7067 # applied to:
7068 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7069
7070 # outputs:
7071 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7072
7073 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007074
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007075 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7076
7077 # applied to:
7078 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007079
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007080 # outputs:
7081 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007082
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007083http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7084 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7085
7086 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7087 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007088 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7089 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7090 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007091
7092 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7093 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7094 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7095
7096 Example:
7097 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7098 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7099
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007100 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7101 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7102 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7103 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7104
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007105http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7106 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7107
7108 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7109 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7110 query-string are replaced.
7111
7112 Example:
7113 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7114 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7115
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007116http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7117 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7118
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007119 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7120 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7121 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7122 against.
7123
7124 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7125 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7126 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007127
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007128 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7129 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7130 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7131 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7132 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7133 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7134 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7135 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7136 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007137 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7138 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007139
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007140 Example:
7141 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7142 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007143
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007144 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7145 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007146
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007147http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7148 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007149
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007150 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7151 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7152 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7153 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007154
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007155 Example:
7156 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007157
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007158 # applied to:
7159 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007160
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007161 # outputs:
7162 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007163
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007164http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7165 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7166 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007167 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007168 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7169
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007170 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007171 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7172 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007173 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007174 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007175 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007176 are followed to create the response :
7177
7178 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7179 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7180 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7181 ignored.
7182
7183 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7184 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007185 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007186 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7187 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007188
7189 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7190 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7191 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007192 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007193 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007194
7195 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7196 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7197 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007198 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007199 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007200 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007201
7202 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7203 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7204 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7205 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7206 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7207 as a raw content.
7208
7209 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7210 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7211 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7212 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7213 considered as a raw string.
7214
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007215 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007216 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7217 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7218 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7219
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007220 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7221 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007222 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007223
7224 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7225
7226 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007227 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007228 if { path /ping }
7229
7230 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7231 if { path /favicon.ico }
7232
7233 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7234 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7235 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7236
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007237http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7238 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7239
7240 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7241 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7242 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7243 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7244 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7245 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7246 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7247 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7248 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7249
7250 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7251 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7252 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7253 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7254 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7255 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7256
7257 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7258 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7259 uploaded bytes, etc).
7260
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007261http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7262
7263 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7264 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7265 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7266 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7267 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7268 at this index.
7269 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7270 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7271
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007272http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7273http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007275 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7276 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7277 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007278
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007279http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7280 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7281 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7282 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7283 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7284 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7285 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7286 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7287 at this index.
7288 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7289 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7290
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007291http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7292 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007293
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007294 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7295 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7296 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7297 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007298
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007299http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7300 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7301
7302 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7303 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7304 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7305 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7306 agent name must be used.
7307
7308 Arguments:
7309 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7310
7311 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7312 configuration.
7313
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007314http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7315 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007316
7317 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7318 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7319 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7320 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7321 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7322 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7323 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7324 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7325
7326 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7327 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7328 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7329
7330 Arguments:
7331 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7332 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7333 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7334 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7335
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007336 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7337 bytes.
7338
7339 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7340 milliseconds.
7341
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007342 Example:
7343 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7344 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7345
7346 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007348http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007349
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007350 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7351 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7352 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7353 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7354 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007355
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007356 Arguments:
7357 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7358 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007359
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007360 Example:
7361 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7362 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007363
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007364 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7365 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007366
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007367http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007368
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007369 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7370 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7371 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007373 Arguments:
7374 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7375 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007376
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007377 Example:
7378 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7379 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007380
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007381 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7382 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7383 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007384
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007385http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007386
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007387 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7388 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7389 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7390 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7391 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007392
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007393 Example:
7394 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7395 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7396 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7397 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7398 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7399 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7400 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7401 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7402 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007404http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007406 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7407 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7408 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7409 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7410 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007411
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007412http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7413 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007414
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007415 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7416 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7417 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7418 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7419 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7420 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7421 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7422 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7423 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007424
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007425http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007426
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007427 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7428 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7429 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7430 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7431 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7432 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7433 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007434 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7435 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007436
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007437http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007438
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007439 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7440 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7441 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007442
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007443http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007444
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007445 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7446 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7447 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7448 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7449 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7450 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7451 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7452 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007453
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007454http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007456 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7457 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7458 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7459 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7460 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7461 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007462
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007463 Example :
7464 # prepend the host name before the path
7465 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007466
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007467http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7468
7469 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7470 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7471 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7472
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007473http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007474
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007475 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7476 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7477 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7478 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7479 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007480
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007481http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007482
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007483 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7484 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7485 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7486 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7487 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7488 values have higher priority.
7489 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7490 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7491 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7492 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7493 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007495http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007496
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007497 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7498 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7499 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7500 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7501 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7502 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7503 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007504
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007505 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007506
7507 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007508 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7509 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007511http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7512 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7513 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7514 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007515 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7516 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007517
7518 Arguments :
7519 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7520 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007521
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007522 See also "option forwardfor".
7523
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007524 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007525 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7526 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7527
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007528 # After the masking this will track connections
7529 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7530 http-request track-sc0 src
7531
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007532 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7533 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7534
7535http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7536
7537 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7538 expression.
7539
7540 Arguments:
7541 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7542 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007543
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007544 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007545 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7546 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7547
7548 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7549 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7550 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7551
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007552http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007553 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7554
7555 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7556 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7557 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7558 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7559 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7560
7561 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7562 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7563 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7564 results.
7565
7566 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007567 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7568 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007570http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7571
7572 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7573 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7574 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7575 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7576 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7577 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7578 information from the request.
7579
7580 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7581
7582http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7583
7584 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7585 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01007586 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
7587 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
7588 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
7589 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
7590 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007591 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7592
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007593http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7594http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007595
7596 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7597 inline.
7598
7599 Arguments:
7600 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7601 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7602 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7603 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7604 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7605 (request and response)
7606 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7607 processing
7608 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7609 processing
7610 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7611 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7612 and '_'.
7613
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007614 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7615 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05007616 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007617 conditions.
7618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007619 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7620 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007621
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007622 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
7623 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
7624
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007625 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007626 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02007627 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
7628
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007629http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007630
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007631 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
7632 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
7633 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
7634 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
7635 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
7636
7637 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
7638 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
7639 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
7640 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
7641 session tables.
7642
7643 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
7644 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
7645 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
7646 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
7647 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
7648 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
7649 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007650
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007651http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007652
7653 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7654 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7655 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7656 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7657 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007658 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007659 processing.
7660
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007661 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007662 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7663 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7664 rules evaluation.
7665
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007666http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7667http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7668 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7669 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7670 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7671 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007672
7673 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7674 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7675 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007676 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7677 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7678 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7679 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7680 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7681 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007682 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007683 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7684 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7685 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007686 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007687 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7688 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7689 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7690 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7691 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007692
7693http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7694http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7695http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7696
7697 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7698 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01007699 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
7700 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
7701 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
7702 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007703 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7704 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7705 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7706 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7707 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7708 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7709 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7710
7711 Arguments :
7712 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7713 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7714 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7715 select which table entry to update the counters.
7716
7717 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7718 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7719 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7720 that table until the session ends.
7721
7722 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7723 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7724 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7725 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7726 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7727 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7728 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7729 useful information.
7730
7731 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7732 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7733 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7734 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7735 checks that make use of it.
7736
7737http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7738
7739 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007740
7741 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007742 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007743
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007744http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7745
7746 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7747 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7748 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7749 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7750 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7751 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7752
7753 Arguments :
7754 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7755
7756 Example:
7757 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7758
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007759http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7760 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7761
7762 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7763 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7764 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7765 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7766 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7767 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7768 http-buffer-request".
7769
7770 Arguments :
7771
7772 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7773 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7774
7775 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007776 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007777 bytes.
7778
7779 Example:
7780 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7781
7782 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7783
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007784http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007785
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007786 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7787 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7788 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007789
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007790
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007791http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007792 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7793
7794 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007795 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007796
7797 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7798 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7799 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7800 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7801 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7802 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7803
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007804 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7805 supported:
7806 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7807 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7808 - allow
7809 - cache-store <name>
7810 - capture <sample> id <id>
7811 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7812 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7813 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7814 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7815 - redirect <rule>
7816 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7817 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7818 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7819 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7820 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7821 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7822 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7823 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7824 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007825 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007826 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7827 - set-log-level <level>
7828 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7829 - set-mark <mark>
7830 - set-nice <nice>
7831 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7832 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007833 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7834 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01007835 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007836 - strict-mode { on | off }
7837 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7838 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7839 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7840 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7841 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7842
7843 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007845 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007846
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007847 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7848 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7849 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7850 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7851 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7852 a defaults section defining such rules.
7853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007854 Example:
7855 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007856
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007857 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007858
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007859 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7860 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007861
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007862 Example:
7863 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007864
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007865 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007866
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007867 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7868 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007869
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007870 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7871 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007872
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007873http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007874
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007875 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7876 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007877
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007878http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007879
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007880 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007881 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7882 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007883
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007884http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007885
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007886 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7887 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007888
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007889http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007890
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007891 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007892
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007893http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007894
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007895 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7896 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7897 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7898 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7899 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7900 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7901 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007902
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007903 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7904 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7905 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7906 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7907 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007908
7909 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7910 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7911 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7912 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007914http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007915
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007916 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7917 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007918
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007919http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007920
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007921 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7922 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007923
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007924http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007925
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007926 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7927 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007928
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007929http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7930http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7931 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7932 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7933 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7934 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007935
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007936 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7937 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7938 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007939 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007940 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7941 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7942 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007943 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007944 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007945
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007946http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007948 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7949 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7950 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7951 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7952 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7953 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007954
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007955http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7956 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007957
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007958 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7959 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007960
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007961 Example:
7962 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007964 # applied to:
7965 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007967 # outputs:
7968 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007970 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007972http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7973 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007974
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007975 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007976 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007977
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007978 Example:
7979 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007981 # applied to:
7982 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007984 # outputs:
7985 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007986
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007987http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7988 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7989 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007990 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007991 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7992
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007993 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7994 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7995 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007996
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007997http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007998http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7999http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008000
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008001 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8002 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8003 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8004 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008005
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008006http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008007 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008008http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8009 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008010
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008011 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8012 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
8013 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008014
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008015http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8016 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008017
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008018 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8019 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008020
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008021http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8022 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008023
8024 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8025 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8026 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8027
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008028http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008029
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008030 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8031 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8032 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8033 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008035http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8036
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008037 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8038 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008039
8040http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8041
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008042 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8043 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008044
8045http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8046
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008047 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8048 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8049 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008050
8051http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8052
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008053 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8054 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008055
8056http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8057 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8058
8059 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8060 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8061 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8062 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008063
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008064 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008065 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8066 http-response set-status 431
8067 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8068 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008070http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008072 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008073 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8074 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008075
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008076http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8077http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008078
8079 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008080 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8081 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008082
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008083http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008084
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008085 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8086 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008087 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8088 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008089
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008090http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008091
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008092 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8093 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008094
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008095http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8096http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8097http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008098
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008099 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8100 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8101 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008102
8103http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8104
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008105 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008106 about <var-name>.
8107
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008108http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8109 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8110
8111 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008112 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8113 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008114
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008115
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008116http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8117 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8118
8119 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8120 yes | no | yes | yes
8121
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008122 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008123 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8124 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8125 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008126
8127 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8128
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008129 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8130 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8131 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8132 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8133 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8134 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8135 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008136 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008137 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8138 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008139
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008140 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8141 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8142 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8143 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8144 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8145 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8146 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008147 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8148 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8149 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8150 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8151 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8152 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008153
8154 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8155 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8156 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8157 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8158 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8159 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8160 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8161 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008162 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008163 downsides of rare connection failures.
8164
8165 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8166 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8167 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8168 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8169 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8170 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008171 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008172 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8173 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8174 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8175 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8176 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8177
8178 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008179 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8180 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8181 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8182 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008183
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008184 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8185 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008186
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008187 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008188
8189 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8190 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8191 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8192
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008193 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8194 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8195 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8196 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8197 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8198 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8199 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8200 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8201 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8202 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8203 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8204
8205 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8206 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8207 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8208 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8209 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8210
8211 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8212 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008213
8214
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008215http-send-name-header [<header>]
8216 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008217 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8218 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008219 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008220 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8221
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008222 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8223 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8224 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8225 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8226 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8227 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8228 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8229 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8230 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8231 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8232 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8233 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8234 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8235 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8236 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8237 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008238
8239 See also : "server"
8240
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008241id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008242 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8244 no | yes | yes | yes
8245 Arguments : none
8246
8247 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8248 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8249 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008250
8251
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008252ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8253 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8254 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008255 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008256
8257 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8258 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8259 and running).
8260
8261 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8262 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8263 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008264 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008265 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8266
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008267 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8268 "unless" condition is met.
8269
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008270 Example:
8271 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8272 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8273 ignore-persist if url_static
8274
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008275 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8276
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008277load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8278 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8279 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8280 yes | no | yes | yes
8281
8282 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8283 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8284 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008285 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008286 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008287 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8288 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8289 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8290
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008291 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008292 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008293 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008294
8295 Arguments:
8296 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8297 named "server-state-file".
8298
8299 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8300 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8301 name is used as a file name.
8302
8303 none don't load any stat for this backend
8304
8305 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008306 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8307 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8308 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008309 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008310 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008311
8312 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8313 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8314
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008315 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008316
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008317 global
8318 stats socket /tmp/socket
8319 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008320
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008321 defaults
8322 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008323
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008324 backend bk
8325 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8326 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008327
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008328
8329 Then one can run :
8330
8331 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8332
8333 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8334
8335 1
8336 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8337 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8338 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8339
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008340 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008341
8342 global
8343 stats socket /tmp/socket
8344 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8345
8346 defaults
8347 load-server-state-from-file local
8348
8349 backend bk
8350 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8351 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8352
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008353
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008354 Then one can run :
8355
8356 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8357
8358 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8359
8360 1
8361 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8362 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8363 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8364
8365 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8366 "show servers state"
8367
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008368
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008369log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008370log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008371 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008372no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008373 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8375 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008376
8377 Prefix :
8378 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8379 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8380 prefix does not allow arguments.
8381
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008382 Arguments :
8383 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8384 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8385 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8386 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8387 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8388 parameter.
8389
8390 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8391 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8392
8393 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8394 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8395 standard syslog port).
8396
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008397 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8398 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8399 standard syslog port).
8400
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008401 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8402 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8403 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008404 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008405
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008406 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8407 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8408 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8409 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8410 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8411 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8412 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8413 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8414 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8415 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8416 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8417 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008418 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008419 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8420 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8421 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008422 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8423 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008424
8425 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8426 and "fd@2", see above.
8427
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008428 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8429 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8430 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8431 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8432 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8433 having the logs instantly available.
8434
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008435 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8436 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8437 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8438
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008439 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8440 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008441
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008442 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8443 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8444 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8445 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8446 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8447 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8448 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8449 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8450 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8451 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008452 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008453
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008454 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8455 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8456 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8457 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8458 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8459
8460 <sample_size>
8461 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8462 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8463 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8464 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8465 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8466
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008467 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8468 one of the following :
8469
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008470 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8471 field is stripped. This is the default.
8472 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8473 rfc3164.
8474
8475 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008476 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8477
8478 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8479 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8480
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008481 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8482 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8483 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8484 designed to be used with a local log server.
8485
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008486 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8487 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8488 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8489 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8490 systemd logger consumes.
8491
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008492 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8493 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8494 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8495 used with a local log server.
8496
8497 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8498 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8499 designed to be used with a local log server.
8500
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008501 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8502 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8503 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8504 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8505
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008506 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8507
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008508 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8509 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8510 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8511
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008512 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8513 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8514 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8515 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008516
8517 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8518 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8519 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008520 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8521 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8522 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8523 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8524 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008525
8526 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8527
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008528 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8529 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8530 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008531
8532 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8533 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8534 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8535 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8536
8537 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8538 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008539
8540 Example :
8541 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008542 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8543 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8544 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008545 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008546 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8547 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008548 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008549
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008550
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008551log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008552 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8553 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8554 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008555
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008556 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8557 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8558 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8559 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8560 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008561 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8562 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008563
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008564 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8565 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008566
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008567log-format-sd <string>
8568 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8569 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8570 yes | yes | yes | no
8571
8572 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8573 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8574 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8575 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8576 which covers the log format string in depth.
8577
8578 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8579 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8580
8581 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8582 log format to "rfc5424".
8583
8584 Example :
8585 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8586
8587
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008588log-tag <string>
8589 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8590 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8591 yes | yes | yes | yes
8592
8593 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8594 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008595 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008596 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8597 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8598 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8599 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8600 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8601 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008602
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008603max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8604 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8605 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8606 yes | no | yes | yes
8607
8608 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
8609 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
8610 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
8611 servers.
8612
8613 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008614 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008615 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
8616 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
8617 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008618 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008619 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
8620 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
8621 picking a different server.
8622
8623 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
8624 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
8625 even if they have to be queued.
8626
8627 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
8628 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
8629
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01008630max-session-srv-conns <nb>
8631 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
8632 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
8633 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008634
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008635maxconn <conns>
8636 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
8637 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8638 yes | yes | yes | no
8639 Arguments :
8640 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
8641 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
8642 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
8643 closes.
8644
8645 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008646 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008647 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
8648 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01008649 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
8650 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
8651 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
8652 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008653
8654 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
8655 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
8656 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
8657
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01008658 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
8659 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02008660
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008661 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
8662
8663
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02008664mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008665 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
8666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8667 yes | yes | yes | yes
8668 Arguments :
8669 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8670 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8671 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8672 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8673
8674 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8675 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8676 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8677 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8678 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8679
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008680 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8681 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8682 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008683
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008684 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008685 defaults http_instances
8686 mode http
8687
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008688
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008689monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008690 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8692 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008693 Arguments :
8694 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8695 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008696 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008697 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8698 backend and its backup.
8699
8700 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8701 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8702 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8703 servers in a list of backends.
8704
8705 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8706 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8707 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008708 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008709 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8710 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008711 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008712 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8713 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008714
8715 Example:
8716 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008717 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008718 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8719 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8720 monitor-uri /site_alive
8721 monitor fail if site_dead
8722
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008723 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008724
8725
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008726monitor-uri <uri>
8727 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8728 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8729 yes | yes | yes | no
8730 Arguments :
8731 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8732 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8733
8734 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8735 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8736 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8737 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8738 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8739 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8740 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8741 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8742
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008743 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008744 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8745 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01008746 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
8747 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
8748 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008749 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8750 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8751 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008752
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008753 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8754 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8755 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8756 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8757
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008758 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008759 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008760 frontend www
8761 mode http
8762 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8763
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008764 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008765
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008766
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008767option abortonclose
8768no option abortonclose
8769 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8771 yes | no | yes | yes
8772 Arguments : none
8773
8774 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8775 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8776 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8777 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008778 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008779 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8780 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8781 encountered while delivering the response.
8782
8783 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8784 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8785 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8786 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8787 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8788 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008789 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008790 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008791 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008792 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8793 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8794 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8795
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008796 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8797 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008798 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8799 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8800 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8801 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8802 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8803 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008804 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008805
8806 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8807 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8808
8809 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8810
8811
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008812option accept-invalid-http-request
8813no option accept-invalid-http-request
8814 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8816 yes | yes | yes | no
8817 Arguments : none
8818
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008819 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008820 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008821 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008822 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8823 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8824 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8825 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8826 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008827 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8828 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8829 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8830 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008831 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008832 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008833 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02008834 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
8835 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008836
8837 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8838 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8839 been confirmed.
8840
8841 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8842 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008843 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8844 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008845 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8846
8847 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8848 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8849
8850 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8851 stats socket.
8852
8853
8854option accept-invalid-http-response
8855no option accept-invalid-http-response
8856 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8858 yes | no | yes | yes
8859 Arguments : none
8860
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008861 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008862 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008863 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008864 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8865 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8866 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8867 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8868 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008869 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8870 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8871 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008872
8873 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8874 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8875 been confirmed.
8876
8877 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8878 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8879 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8880 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8881
8882 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8883 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8884
8885 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8886 stats socket.
8887
8888
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008889option allbackups
8890no option allbackups
8891 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8893 yes | no | yes | yes
8894 Arguments : none
8895
8896 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8897 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8898 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8899 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8900 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8901 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8902 order between the backup servers anymore.
8903
8904 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8905 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8906
8907 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8908 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8909
8910
8911option checkcache
8912no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008913 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8915 yes | no | yes | yes
8916 Arguments : none
8917
8918 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8919 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008920 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008921 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8922 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008923 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008924
8925 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008926 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008927 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008928 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8929 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008930 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008931 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008932 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8933 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008934 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008935 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8936 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008937 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008938 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8939 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8940 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8941 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8942 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8943 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8944 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8945 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8946 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8947
8948 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008949 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8950 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8951 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8952 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008953
8954 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8955 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008956 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008957 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008958
8959 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8960 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8961
8962
8963option clitcpka
8964no option clitcpka
8965 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8967 yes | yes | yes | no
8968 Arguments : none
8969
8970 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8971 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008972 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008973 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8974
8975 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8976 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8977 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8978 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8979
8980 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8981 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8982 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8983 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8984 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8985
8986 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8987
8988 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8989 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8990 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8991
8992 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8993 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8994
8995 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8996
8997
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008998option contstats
8999 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9001 yes | yes | yes | no
9002 Arguments : none
9003
9004 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9005 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9006 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009007 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009008 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9009 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9010 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9011 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9012 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009013
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009014option disable-h2-upgrade
9015no option disable-h2-upgrade
9016 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9017 connection.
9018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9019 yes | yes | yes | no
9020 Arguments : none
9021
9022 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9023 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9024 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9025 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009026 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9027 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9028 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9029 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9030 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9031 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009032
9033 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9034 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009035
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009036option dontlog-normal
9037no option dontlog-normal
9038 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9039 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9040 yes | yes | yes | no
9041 Arguments : none
9042
9043 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9044 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9045 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9046 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9047 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9048 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9049 logged.
9050
9051 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9052 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9053 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009055 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009056 logging.
9057
9058
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009059option dontlognull
9060no option dontlognull
9061 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9063 yes | yes | yes | no
9064 Arguments : none
9065
9066 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9067 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9068 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9069 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9070 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9071 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009072 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9073 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9074 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009075
9076 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009077 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009078 would not be logged.
9079
9080 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9081 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9082
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009083 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009084 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009085
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009086option forwarded [ proto ]
9087 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9088 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9089 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9090no option forwarded
9091 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9092 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9093 yes | no | yes | yes
9094 Arguments :
9095 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9096 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9097
9098 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9099 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9100
9101 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9102 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9103
9104 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9105 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9106
9107 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9108 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9109
9110
9111 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are loosing some request
9112 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9113
9114 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9115 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9116 underlying servers/applications.
9117 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9118 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9119 issues.
9120
9121 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9122 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9123 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9124
9125 The use of this single header allow to convey multiple informations
9126 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9127 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9128 values to an already existing header).
9129
9130 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9131 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9132
9133 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9134 behavior.
9135 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9136
9137 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
9138 option forwarded proto for
9139
9140 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9141 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9142 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9143 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9144 "unknown".
9145
9146 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9147 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9148 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9149 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9150
9151 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9152 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9153 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9154 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9155 "unknown".
9156
9157 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9158 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9159 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9160 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9161
9162 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9163 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9164 it will be ignored.
9165 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9166 otherwise it will be ignored.
9167
9168 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9169 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9170 it will be ignored.
9171 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9172 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9173
9174 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9175 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9176 it will be ignored.
9177 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9178 otherwise it will be ignored.
9179
9180 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9181 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9182 it will be ignored.
9183 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9184 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9185
9186 Examples :
9187 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9188 # Resulting header would look like this:
9189 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9190 backend www_default
9191 mode http
9192 option forwarded
9193 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9194
9195 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9196 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9197 # ip privacy is a concern)
9198 # Resulting header would look like this:
9199 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9200 backend www_host
9201 mode http
9202 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9203
9204 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9205 # Resulting header would look like this:
9206 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9207 backend www_custom
9208 mode http
9209 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9210
9211 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9212 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9213 # Resulting header would look like this:
9214 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9215 backend www_for_hide
9216 mode http
9217 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9218
9219 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009220
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009221option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009222 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9223 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9224 yes | yes | yes | yes
9225 Arguments :
9226 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9227 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009228 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009229 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009230
9231 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9232 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9233 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9234 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9235 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9236 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9237 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009238 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9239 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9240 possible that the client has already brought one.
9241
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009242 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009243 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009244 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009245 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009246 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009247 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009248
9249 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9250 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9251 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9252 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9253 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9254 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009255 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009256
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009257 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9258 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009259 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009260 are under the control of the end-user.
9261
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009262 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009263 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9264 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009265 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9266 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9267 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009268
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009269 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009270 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9271 frontend www
9272 mode http
9273 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9274
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009275 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9276 backend www
9277 mode http
9278 option forwardfor header X-Client
9279
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009280 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009281 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009282
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009283
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009284option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9285no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9286 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9288 yes | yes | yes | no
9289 Arguments : none
9290
9291 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9292 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9293 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9294 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9295 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9296 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9297 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9298
9299 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9300 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9301 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9302 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9303 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9304 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9305 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9306 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9307 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9308 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9309
9310 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9311
9312 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9313 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9314
9315 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9316 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9317
9318
9319option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9320no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9321 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9323 yes | no | yes | yes
9324 Arguments : none
9325
9326 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9327 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9328 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9329 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9330 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9331 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9332 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9333
9334 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9335 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9336 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9337 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9338 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9339 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9340 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9341 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9342 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9343 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9344
9345 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9346
9347 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9348 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9349
9350 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9351 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9352
9353
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009354option http-buffer-request
9355no option http-buffer-request
9356 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9358 yes | yes | yes | yes
9359 Arguments : none
9360
9361 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9362 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9363 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9364 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9365 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9366 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009367 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9368 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9369 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9370 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009371
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009372 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9373 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009374
9375
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009376option http-ignore-probes
9377no option http-ignore-probes
9378 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9380 yes | yes | yes | no
9381 Arguments : none
9382
9383 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9384 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9385 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9386 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9387 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9388 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9389 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9390 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9391 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009392 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9393 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009394 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9395
9396 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9397 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9398 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9399 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9400 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9401 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9402 are often the only way to detect them.
9403
9404 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9405 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9406
9407 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9408
9409
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009410option http-keep-alive
9411no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009412 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9413 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9415 yes | yes | yes | yes
9416 Arguments : none
9417
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009418 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009419 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9420 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9421 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9422 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9423 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009424
9425 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9426 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009427 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9428 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9429 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9430 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9431 situations where this option may be useful :
9432
9433 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009434 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009435
9436 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9437 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9438
9439 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009440
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009441 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9442 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9443 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9444 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9445 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9446 not set.
9447
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009448 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009449 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009450
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009451 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009452 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009453
9454
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009455option http-no-delay
9456no option http-no-delay
9457 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9459 yes | yes | yes | yes
9460 Arguments : none
9461
9462 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9463 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9464 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9465 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9466 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9467 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9468 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009469 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009470 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9471 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9472 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9473 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9474 affected.
9475
9476 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9477 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9478 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9479 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9480 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9481 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9482 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9483 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9484 latency environments.
9485
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009486 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9487
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009488
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009489option http-pretend-keepalive
9490no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009491 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9492 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009494 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009495 Arguments : none
9496
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009497 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009498 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9499 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9500 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9501 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9502 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
9503 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009504
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009505 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009506 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009507 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009508 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009509 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009510 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9511
9512 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9513 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9514 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9515 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009516 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9517 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009518 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9519
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009520 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9521 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9522 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009523 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009524
9525 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9526 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9527
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009528 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009529 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009530
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009531option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9532 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9533 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9535 yes | yes | yes | yes
9536 Arguments :
9537 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9538 with no FastCGI application configured.
9539
9540 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9541 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9542 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9543
9544 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9545 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9546
9547 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9548 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9549 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9550 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9551 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9552 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9553 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9554 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9555
9556 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9557 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009558
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009559option http-server-close
9560no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009561 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9563 yes | yes | yes | yes
9564 Arguments : none
9565
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009566 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009567 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9568 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9569 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9570 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
9571 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
9572 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
9573 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
9574 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
9575 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
9576 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
9577 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
9578 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
9579 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009580
9581 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9582 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9583 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9584 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009585 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9586 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009587
9588 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9589 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009590 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9591 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9592 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009593
9594 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9595 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9596
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009597 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
9598 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009599
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009600option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009601no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009602 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9604 yes | yes | yes | no
9605 Arguments : none
9606
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00009607 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009608 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
9609 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
9610 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
9611 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
9612 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009613 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009614
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009615 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009616 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01009617 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
9618 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
9619 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009620
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01009621 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
9622 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
9623 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
9624 front of an existing proxy.
9625
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009626 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
9627
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009628 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009629
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009630option httpchk
9631option httpchk <uri>
9632option httpchk <method> <uri>
9633option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009634 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9636 yes | no | yes | yes
9637 Arguments :
9638 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
9639 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
9640 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
9641 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
9642 ones.
9643
9644 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
9645 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
9646 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
9647
9648 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
9649 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
9650 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02009651 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009652
9653 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
9654 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
9655 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
9656 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
9657 the lack of any response.
9658
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009659 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
9660 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
9661 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
9662 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
9663
9664 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
9665 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
9666 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009667
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02009668 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
9669 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009670 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04009671 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02009672 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009673
9674 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009675 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
9676 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
9677 backend https_relay
9678 mode tcp
9679 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
9680 http-check send hdr Host www
9681 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009682
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09009683 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
9684 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
9685 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009686
9687
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009688option httpclose
9689no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009690 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9692 yes | yes | yes | yes
9693 Arguments : none
9694
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009695 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009696 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9697 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9698 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9699 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009700
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009701 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +01009702 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
9703 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009704 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
9705 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
9706 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009707
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009708 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009709 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
9710 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009711
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009712 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009713 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009714
9715 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9716 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9717
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009718 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009719
9720
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009721option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009722 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
9723 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009724 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009725 Arguments :
9726 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
9727 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
9728 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009729 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009730 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009731
9732 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9733 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9734 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9735 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9736 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9737 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
9738 ports.
9739
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01009740 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
9741 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02009742
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009743 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9744
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009745 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009746
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02009747option httpslog
9748 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
9749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9750 yes | yes | yes | no
9751
9752 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9753 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9754 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
9755 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
9756 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
9757 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
9758 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
9759
9760 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9761
9762 See also : section 8 about logging.
9763
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009764
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009765option independent-streams
9766no option independent-streams
9767 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9769 yes | yes | yes | yes
9770 Arguments : none
9771
9772 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9773 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9774 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9775 receive data or not.
9776
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009777 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009778 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9779 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9780 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9781 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9782 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9783 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9784 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9785 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9786 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9787 socket buffers.
9788
9789 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9790 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9791 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9792 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9793 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9794
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009795 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009796
9797
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009798option ldap-check
9799 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9801 yes | no | yes | yes
9802 Arguments : none
9803
9804 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9805 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9806 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9807 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9808
9809 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9810 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9811
9812 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9813 configure it.
9814
9815 Example :
9816 option ldap-check
9817
9818 See also : "option httpchk"
9819
9820
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009821option external-check
9822 Use external processes for server health checks
9823 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9824 yes | no | yes | yes
9825
9826 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9827 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9828 command".
9829
9830 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9831
9832 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9833
9834
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009835option idle-close-on-response
9836no option idle-close-on-response
9837 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9839 yes | yes | yes | no
9840 Arguments : none
9841
9842 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9843 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9844 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9845 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9846 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9847 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9848 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9849 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9850 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9851
9852 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9853 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9854
9855 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9856 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9857 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9858 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9859
9860 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9861 "hard-stop-after"
9862
9863
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009864option log-health-checks
9865no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009866 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9868 yes | no | yes | yes
9869 Arguments : none
9870
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009871 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9872 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9873 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009874
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009875 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9876 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9877 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9878 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9879 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9880
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009881 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009882 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009883
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009884 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9885 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9886 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009887
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009888
9889option log-separate-errors
9890no option log-separate-errors
9891 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9893 yes | yes | yes | no
9894 Arguments : none
9895
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009896 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009897 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9898 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9899 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9900 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9901 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9902 provides very important information.
9903
9904 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9905 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9906 error logs.
9907
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009908 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009909 logging.
9910
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009911
9912option logasap
9913no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009914 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9916 yes | yes | yes | no
9917 Arguments : none
9918
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009919 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9920 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9921 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9922 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9923
9924 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9925 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9926 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9927 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9928 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009929 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009930 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9931 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9932 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9933 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009934 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009935
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009936 Examples :
9937 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9938 mode http
9939 option httplog
9940 option logasap
9941 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9942
9943 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9944 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9945 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9946 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9947
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009948 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009949 logging.
9950
9951
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009952option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009953 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9955 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009956 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009957 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9958 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009959 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9960 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009961
9962 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9963 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009964 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009965 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009966 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9967 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9968 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009969
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009970 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9971 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9972 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009973
9974 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009975 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009976 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9977 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9978 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9979 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9980 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9981 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9982 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9983
9984 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9985 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009986
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009987 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009988
9989 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9990 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9991 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9992 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009993 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009994 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009995
9996 See also: "option httpchk"
9997
9998
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009999option nolinger
10000no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010001 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010002 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10003 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010004 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010005
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010006 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010007 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10008 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10009 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10010 connections.
10011
10012 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10013 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010014 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10015 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10016 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10017 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10018 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10019 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10020 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10021 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10022 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10023 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10024 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10025 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10026 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010027
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010028 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10029 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10030 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10031 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10032 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010033
10034 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10035 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010036 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010037 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010038 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010039
10040 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10041 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10042
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010043 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10044 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010045
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010046option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10047 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10049 yes | yes | yes | yes
10050 Arguments :
10051 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10052 matching <network>
10053 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10054 header name.
10055
10056 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10057 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10058 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10059 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10060 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10061 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10062 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10063 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10064 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10065 possible that the client has already brought one.
10066
10067 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10068 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10069 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10070 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10071 header and requires different one.
10072
10073 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10074 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10075 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010076 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10077 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10078 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10079 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10080 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010081
10082 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10083 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10084 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10085 both are defined.
10086
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010087 Examples :
10088 # Original Destination address
10089 frontend www
10090 mode http
10091 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10092
10093 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10094 backend www
10095 mode http
10096 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10097
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010098 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010099
10100
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010101option persist
10102no option persist
10103 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10104 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10105 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010106 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010107
10108 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10109 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10110 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10111 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10112 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10113 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10114 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10115 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10116 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10117 redirected to another valid server.
10118
10119 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10120 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10121
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010122 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010123
10124
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010125option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010126 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10128 yes | no | yes | yes
10129 Arguments :
10130 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10131 PostgreSQL server.
10132
10133 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10134 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10135 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10136 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10137
10138 See also: "option httpchk"
10139
10140
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010141option prefer-last-server
10142no option prefer-last-server
10143 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10144 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10145 yes | no | yes | yes
10146 Arguments : none
10147
10148 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010149 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010150 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10151 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010152 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010153 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010154 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010155 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10156 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010157 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010158 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010159 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10160 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10161 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010162 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10163 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10164 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010165
10166 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10167 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10168
10169 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10170
10171
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010172option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010173option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010174no option redispatch
10175 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10176 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10177 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010178 Arguments :
10179 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10180 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10181 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010182 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010183 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010184 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010185 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10186 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10187 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10188
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010189
10190 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10191 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10192 be able to access the service anymore.
10193
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010194 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10195 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010196
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010197 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10198 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10199 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10200 following order:
10201
10202 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10203
10204 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10205 list, or
10206
10207 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10208
10209 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10210 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10211
10212 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10213 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10214 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10215 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10216
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010217 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010218 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10219 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010220
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010221 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10222 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10223
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010224 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010225
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010226
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010227option redis-check
10228 Use redis health checks for server testing
10229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10230 yes | no | yes | yes
10231 Arguments : none
10232
10233 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10234 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10235 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10236 find the "+PONG" response message.
10237
10238 Example :
10239 option redis-check
10240
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010241 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010242
10243
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010244option smtpchk
10245option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10246 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10247 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10248 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010249 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010250 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010251 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010252 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10253
10254 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10255 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10256 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10257
10258 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10259 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10260 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10261 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10262 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10263 dead server.
10264
10265 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10266 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010267 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010268 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10269
10270 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10271 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10272 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10273 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010274 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010275
10276 Example :
10277 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10278
10279 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010282option socket-stats
10283no option socket-stats
10284
10285 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10287 yes | yes | yes | no
10288
10289 Arguments : none
10290
10291
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010292option splice-auto
10293no option splice-auto
10294 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10296 yes | yes | yes | yes
10297 Arguments : none
10298
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010299 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010300 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010301 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010302 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010303 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010304 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10305 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10306 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10307 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10308
10309 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10310 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10311 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10312 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10313 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10314 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10315 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10316 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10317 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10318 keyword.
10319
10320 Example :
10321 option splice-auto
10322
10323 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10324 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10325
10326 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10327 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10328
10329
10330option splice-request
10331no option splice-request
10332 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10334 yes | yes | yes | yes
10335 Arguments : none
10336
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010337 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010338 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010339 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10340 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10341 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10342 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10343
10344 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10345
10346 Example :
10347 option splice-request
10348
10349 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10350 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10351
10352 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10353 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10354
10355
10356option splice-response
10357no option splice-response
10358 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10359 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10360 yes | yes | yes | yes
10361 Arguments : none
10362
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010363 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010364 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010365 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10366 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10367 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10368 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10369
10370 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10371
10372 Example :
10373 option splice-response
10374
10375 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10376 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10377
10378 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10379 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10380
10381
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010382option spop-check
10383 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10384 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010385 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010386 Arguments : none
10387
10388 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10389 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10390 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10391 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10392
10393 Example :
10394 option spop-check
10395
10396 See also : "option httpchk"
10397
10398
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010399option srvtcpka
10400no option srvtcpka
10401 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10403 yes | no | yes | yes
10404 Arguments : none
10405
10406 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10407 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010408 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010409 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10410
10411 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10412 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10413 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10414 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10415
10416 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10417 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10418 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10419 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10420 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10421
10422 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10423
10424 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10425 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10426 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10427
10428 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10429 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10430
10431 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10432
10433
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010434option ssl-hello-chk
10435 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10437 yes | no | yes | yes
10438 Arguments : none
10439
10440 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10441 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10442 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10443 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10444 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10445 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10446 hello message.
10447
10448 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10449 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10450 messages, which is appreciable.
10451
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010452 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010453 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10454 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010455
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010456 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10457
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010458
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010459option tcp-check
10460 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10461 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10462 yes | no | yes | yes
10463
10464 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10465 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10466
10467 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10468 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10469 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10470
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010471 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010472 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10473 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10474 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10475 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10476 only.
10477
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010478 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010479 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010480 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10481 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10482 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10483
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010484 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010485 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10486 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010487 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010488 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10489 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10490 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10491 the respective protocols.
10492 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010493 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010495 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010496
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010497 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10498 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10499 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10500 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010501
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010502 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10503 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10504 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010505
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010506
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010507 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010508 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010509 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010510 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010511
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010512 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010513 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010514 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010515
10516 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10517 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010518 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010519 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010520 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010521 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010522 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010523 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010524 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10525 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010526 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010527 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10528 tcp-check expect string +OK
10529
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010530 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010531 (send many headers before analyzing)
10532 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010533 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010534 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10535 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10536 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10537 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010538 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010539
10540
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010541 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010542
10543
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010544option tcp-smart-accept
10545no option tcp-smart-accept
10546 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10548 yes | yes | yes | no
10549 Arguments : none
10550
10551 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10552 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10553 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10554 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10555 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10556 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10557
10558 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10559 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10560 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10561 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10562
10563 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10564 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10565 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010566 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010567
10568 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10569 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10570 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10571
10572 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10573 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10574 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10575
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010576 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10577
10578
10579option tcp-smart-connect
10580no option tcp-smart-connect
10581 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10583 yes | no | yes | yes
10584 Arguments : none
10585
10586 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10587 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10588 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10589 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10590 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10591
10592 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10593 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10594 complex.
10595
10596 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10597 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10598 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10599
10600 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10601 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10602
10603 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
10604
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010605
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010606option tcpka
10607 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
10608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10609 yes | yes | yes | yes
10610 Arguments : none
10611
10612 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10613 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010614 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010615 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10616
10617 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10618 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10619 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10620 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10621
10622 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10623 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10624 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10625 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10626 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10627
10628 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10629
10630 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
10631 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
10632 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
10633 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
10634 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
10635 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
10636 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
10637 backends.
10638
10639 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
10640
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010641
10642option tcplog
10643 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
10644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010645 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010646 Arguments : none
10647
10648 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10649 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10650 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
10651 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
10652 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
10653 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
10654 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
10655 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
10656
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010657 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10658
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010659 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010660
10661
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010662option transparent
10663no option transparent
10664 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010666 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010667 Arguments : none
10668
10669 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
10670 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10671 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10672 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10673 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10674 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10675 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10676 appropriate server.
10677
10678 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10679 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10680
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010010681 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010682 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010683
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010684
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010685external-check command <command>
10686 Executable to run when performing an external-check
10687 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10688 yes | no | yes | yes
10689
10690 Arguments :
10691 <command> is the external command to run
10692
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010693 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
10694
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010695 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010696
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010010697 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
10698 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
10699 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
10700 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
10701 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
10702 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010703
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010704 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
10705
10706 Environment variables :
10707 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
10708 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
10709
10710 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
10711
10712 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
10713
10714 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
10715 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
10716 for a UNIX socket).
10717
10718 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
10719
10720 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
10721
10722 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
10723
10724 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
10725
10726 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
10727
10728 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
10729 socket).
10730
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020010731 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
10732
10733 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
10734 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
10735 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
10736 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
10737 TCP server).
10738
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010010739 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
10740 the command may be set using "external-check path".
10741
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020010742 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
10743
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010744 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
10745 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
10746 failed.
10747
10748 Example :
10749 external-check command /bin/true
10750
10751 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
10752
10753
10754external-check path <path>
10755 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
10756 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10757 yes | no | yes | yes
10758
10759 Arguments :
10760 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
10761
10762 The default path is "".
10763
10764 Example :
10765 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
10766
10767 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
10768 "external-check command"
10769
10770
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010771persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020010772persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010773 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
10774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10775 yes | no | yes | yes
10776 Arguments :
10777 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010778 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10779 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010780
10781 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10782 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010783 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010784 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10785 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10786 forwarded to this server.
10787
10788 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10789 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10790 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010791 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010792 a single "listen" section.
10793
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010794 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10795 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10796 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10797
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010798 Example :
10799 listen tse-farm
10800 bind :3389
10801 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10802 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10803 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10804 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10805 persist rdp-cookie
10806 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010807 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010808 balance rdp-cookie
10809 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10810 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10811
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010812 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010813
10814
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010815rate-limit sessions <rate>
10816 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10817 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10818 yes | yes | yes | no
10819 Arguments :
10820 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10821 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10822
10823 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10824 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10825 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010826 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010827 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10828 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10829
10830 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10831 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10832 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10833 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10834
10835 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10836 listen smtp
10837 mode tcp
10838 bind :25
10839 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010840 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010841
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010842 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10843 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10844 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010845
10846 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10847
10848
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010849redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10850redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10851redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010852 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10854 no | yes | yes | yes
10855
10856 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010857 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010858
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010859 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010860 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010861 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10862 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10863 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010864
10865 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10866 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10867 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10868 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10869 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010870 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10871 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10872 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10873 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010874
10875 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10876 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10877 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10878 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10879 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10880 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010881 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010882 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010883 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10884 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10885 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010886
10887 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010888 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10889 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10890 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010891 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010892 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10893 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10894 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10895 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010896
10897 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010898 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010899
10900 - "drop-query"
10901 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10902 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10903 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10904 with a location-type redirect.
10905
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010906 - "append-slash"
10907 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10908 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10909 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10910 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10911
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010912 - "ignore-empty"
10913 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10914 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10915 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10916 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10917 of known paths using a simple map.
10918
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010919 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10920 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10921 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10922 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10923 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10924 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10925 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10926
10927 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10928 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10929 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10930 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10931 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10932 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10933 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010934
10935 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10936 acl clear dst_port 80
10937 acl secure dst_port 8080
10938 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010939 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010940 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010941 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10942
10943 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010944 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10945 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10946 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010947 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010948
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010949 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10950 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10951 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10952
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010953 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010954 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010955
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010956 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010957 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10958 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10959 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010960
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010961 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10962 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10963 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10964
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010965 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010966
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010967
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010968retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010969 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010970 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10971 yes | no | yes | yes
10972 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010973 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
10974 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010975
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010976 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
10977 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
10978 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
10979 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
10980 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010981
10982 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010983 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010984 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010985
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010010986 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
10987 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
10988 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010989
10990 See also : "option redispatch"
10991
10992
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010993retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010994 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10995 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10996 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10998 yes | no | yes | yes
10999 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011000 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11001 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11002 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11003 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11004 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011005
11006 none never retry
11007
11008 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11009 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11010
11011 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11012 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11013 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11014 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11015 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11016 processing the request.
11017
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011018 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11019 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11020 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11021 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11022 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11023 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11024 overflow attack for example).
11025
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011026 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11027 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11028 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11029 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11030 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11031 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11032 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11033 amplify denial of service attacks.
11034
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011035 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11036 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11037 considered to be safe to retry.
11038
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011039 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11040 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11041 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11042 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11043 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011044
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011045 all-retryable-errors
11046 retry request for any error that are considered
11047 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11048 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11049 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
11050
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011051 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11052 not cumulative.
11053
11054 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11055 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11056 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11057 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11058
11059 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11060 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11061 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11062 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11063 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11064 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11065 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11066 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11067 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11068 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11069 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11070 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11071
11072 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11073 should not use this directive.
11074
11075 The default is "conn-failure".
11076
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011077 Example:
11078 retry-on 503 504
11079
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011080 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11081
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011082server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011083 Declare a server in a backend
11084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11085 no | no | yes | yes
11086 Arguments :
11087 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011088 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011089 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011090
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011091 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11092 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11093 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11094 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011095 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11096 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011097 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011098 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11099 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011100 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11101 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11102 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11103 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11104 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11105 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11106 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011107 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011108 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11109 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11110 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11111 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11112 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11113 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011114 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11115 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011116 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11117 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011118
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011119 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011120 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11121 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11122 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11123 adding this value to the client's port.
11124
11125 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11126 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011127 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011128
11129 Examples :
11130 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11131 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011132 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011133 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11134 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11135 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011136
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011137 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11138 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11139 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11140 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11141 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11142
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011143 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11144 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011145
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011146server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011147 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011148 this backend.
11149 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11150 no | no | yes | yes
11151
11152 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11153 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11154 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11155 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11156 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011157
11158 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11159 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11160
11161 global
11162 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11163
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011164 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011165 load-server-state-from-file
11166
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011167 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011168 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011169
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011170server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11171 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11172 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11173 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11174 no | no | yes | yes
11175
11176 Arguments:
11177 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11178
11179 <num | range>
11180 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11181 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11182 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11183 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11184
11185 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11186
11187 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11188
11189 <params*>
11190 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11191 keyword.
11192
11193 Examples:
11194 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11195 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11196 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11197
11198 # or
11199 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11200
11201 # would be equivalent to:
11202 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11203 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11204 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11205
11206
11207
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011208source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011209source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011210source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011211 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11213 yes | no | yes | yes
11214 Arguments :
11215 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11216 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011217
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011218 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011219 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11220 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11221 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11222 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11223 supported prefixes are :
11224 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11225 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11226 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011227 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011228 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11229 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011230
11231 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11232 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011233 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11234 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11235 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011236
11237 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11238 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11239 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11240 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11241 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11242 <addr>.
11243
11244 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11245 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11246 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11247 port.
11248
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011249 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11250 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11251 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11252 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011253 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011254 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11255 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11256 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11257 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11258 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11259 HTTP header.
11260
11261 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11262 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011263 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011264 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11265 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11266 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11267 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11268 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11269 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11270 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11271
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011272 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11273 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11274 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11275 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11276 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11277 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11278
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011279 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11280 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11281 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11282 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11283
11284 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11285 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11286 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11287 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11288 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11289 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11290
11291 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11292 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11293 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11294 there are two methods :
11295
11296 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11297 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11298 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11299 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11300 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11301 of the client ranges may be used.
11302
11303 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11304 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11305 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11306 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11307 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11308 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11309 same session.
11310
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011311 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11312 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11313 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011314 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011315
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011316 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
11317
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011318 Examples :
11319 backend private
11320 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11321 source 192.168.1.200
11322
11323 backend transparent_ssl1
11324 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11325 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11326
11327 backend transparent_ssl2
11328 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11329 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11330 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11331
11332 backend transparent_ssl3
11333 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11334 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11335 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11336
11337 backend transparent_smtp
11338 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11339 # with Tproxy version 4.
11340 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11341
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011342 backend transparent_http
11343 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11344 # proxy.
11345 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11346
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011347 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011348 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11349
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011350
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011351srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11352 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11353 the connection on the server side.
11354 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11355 yes | no | yes | yes
11356 Arguments :
11357 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11358
11359 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11360 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011361 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11362 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011363
11364 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11365
11366
11367srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11368 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11369 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11370 server side.
11371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11372 yes | no | yes | yes
11373 Arguments :
11374 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11375 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11376 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11377 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11378
11379 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11380 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011381 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11382 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011383
11384 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11385
11386
11387srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11388 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11390 yes | no | yes | yes
11391 Arguments :
11392 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11393 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11394 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11395 document.
11396
11397 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11398 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011399 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11400 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011401
11402 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11403
11404
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011405stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11406 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011408 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011409
11410 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11411 matched.
11412
11413 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11414 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11415
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011416 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11417 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11418 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11419 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011420
11421 Example :
11422 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11423 backend stats_localhost
11424 stats enable
11425 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11426
11427 Example :
11428 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11429 backend stats_auth
11430 stats enable
11431 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11432 stats admin if TRUE
11433
11434 Example :
11435 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11436 userlist stats-auth
11437 group admin users admin
11438 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11439 group readonly users haproxy
11440 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11441
11442 backend stats_auth
11443 stats enable
11444 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11445 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11446 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11447 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11448
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011449 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11450 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011451
11452
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011453stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11454 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11455 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011456 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011457 Arguments :
11458 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11459
11460 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11461
11462 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11463 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11464 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11465 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11466 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11467 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11468
11469 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11470 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11471 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011472 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011473
11474 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11475 report using "stats scope".
11476
11477 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11478 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11479 unobvious parameters.
11480
11481 Example :
11482 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11483 backend public_www
11484 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11485 stats enable
11486 stats hide-version
11487 stats scope .
11488 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011489 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011490 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11491 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11492
11493 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11494 backend private_monitoring
11495 stats enable
11496 stats uri /admin?stats
11497 stats refresh 5s
11498
11499 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11500
11501
11502stats enable
11503 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011505 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011506 Arguments : none
11507
11508 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11509 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11510 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11511 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11512 - stats auth : no authentication
11513 - stats scope : no restriction
11514
11515 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11516 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11517 unobvious parameters.
11518
11519 Example :
11520 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11521 backend public_www
11522 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11523 stats enable
11524 stats hide-version
11525 stats scope .
11526 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011527 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011528 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11529 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11530
11531 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11532 backend private_monitoring
11533 stats enable
11534 stats uri /admin?stats
11535 stats refresh 5s
11536
11537 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11538
11539
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011540stats hide-version
11541 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011543 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011544 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011545
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011546 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11547 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11548 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11549 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11550 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11551 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011552
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011553 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11554 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11555 unobvious parameters.
11556
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011557 Example :
11558 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11559 backend public_www
11560 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011561 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011562 stats hide-version
11563 stats scope .
11564 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011565 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011566 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11567 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011568
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011569 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11570 backend private_monitoring
11571 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011572 stats uri /admin?stats
11573 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011574
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011575 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011576
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011577
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011578stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11579 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11580 Access control for statistics
11581
11582 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11583 no | no | yes | yes
11584
11585 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11586 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11587 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11588 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11589 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11590 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11591
11592 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11593 instance.
11594
11595 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11596 about ACL usage.
11597
11598
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011599stats realm <realm>
11600 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011602 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011603 Arguments :
11604 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
11605 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
11606 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
11607
11608 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
11609 using a backslash ('\').
11610
11611 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
11612 only related to authentication.
11613
11614 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11615 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11616 unobvious parameters.
11617
11618 Example :
11619 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11620 backend public_www
11621 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11622 stats enable
11623 stats hide-version
11624 stats scope .
11625 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011626 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011627 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11628 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11629
11630 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11631 backend private_monitoring
11632 stats enable
11633 stats uri /admin?stats
11634 stats refresh 5s
11635
11636 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
11637
11638
11639stats refresh <delay>
11640 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
11641 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011642 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011643 Arguments :
11644 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
11645 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
11646 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
11647 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
11648 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
11649 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
11650
11651 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
11652 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
11653 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050011654 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011655
11656 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11657 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11658 unobvious parameters.
11659
11660 Example :
11661 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11662 backend public_www
11663 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11664 stats enable
11665 stats hide-version
11666 stats scope .
11667 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011668 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011669 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11670 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11671
11672 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11673 backend private_monitoring
11674 stats enable
11675 stats uri /admin?stats
11676 stats refresh 5s
11677
11678 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11679
11680
11681stats scope { <name> | "." }
11682 Enable statistics and limit access scope
11683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011684 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011685 Arguments :
11686 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
11687 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
11688 section in which the statement appears.
11689
11690 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
11691 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
11692 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
11693 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
11694 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
11695 exists.
11696
11697 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11698 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11699 unobvious parameters.
11700
11701 Example :
11702 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11703 backend public_www
11704 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11705 stats enable
11706 stats hide-version
11707 stats scope .
11708 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011709 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011710 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11711 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11712
11713 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11714 backend private_monitoring
11715 stats enable
11716 stats uri /admin?stats
11717 stats refresh 5s
11718
11719 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11720
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011721
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011722stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011723 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
11724 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011725 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011726
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011727 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011728 description from global section is automatically used instead.
11729
11730 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11731 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
11732
11733 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11734 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011735 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011736
11737 Example :
11738 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11739 backend private_monitoring
11740 stats enable
11741 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
11742 stats uri /admin?stats
11743 stats refresh 5s
11744
11745 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
11746 global section.
11747
11748
11749stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011750 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
11751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11752 yes | yes | yes | yes
11753 Arguments : none
11754
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011755 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011756 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
11757 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
11758 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
11759 - IP (socket, server)
11760 - cookie (backend, server)
11761
11762 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11763 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011764 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011765
11766 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11767
11768
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020011769stats show-modules
11770 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
11771 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11772 yes | yes | yes | yes
11773 Arguments : none
11774
11775 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
11776 values as a tooltip.
11777
11778 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11779 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11780 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
11781
11782 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
11783
11784
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011785stats show-node [ <name> ]
11786 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011788 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011789 Arguments:
11790 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11791 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11792
11793 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11794 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011795 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011796
11797 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11798 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11799 unobvious parameters.
11800
11801 Example:
11802 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11803 backend private_monitoring
11804 stats enable
11805 stats show-node Europe-1
11806 stats uri /admin?stats
11807 stats refresh 5s
11808
11809 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11810 section.
11811
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011812
11813stats uri <prefix>
11814 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011816 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011817 Arguments :
11818 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11819 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11820 query string.
11821
11822 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11823 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11824 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11825 possible to reach it in the application.
11826
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011827 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011828 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011829 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11830 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11831 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11832 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11833
11834 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11835 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11836 an address or a port to statistics only.
11837
11838 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11839 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11840 unobvious parameters.
11841
11842 Example :
11843 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11844 backend public_www
11845 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11846 stats enable
11847 stats hide-version
11848 stats scope .
11849 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011850 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011851 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11852 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11853
11854 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11855 backend private_monitoring
11856 stats enable
11857 stats uri /admin?stats
11858 stats refresh 5s
11859
11860 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11861
11862
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011863stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11864 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011866 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011867
11868 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011869 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011870 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011871 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011872 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11873
11874 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11875 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11876 the "stick-table" statement.
11877
11878 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11879 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11880 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11881 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11882 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11883
11884 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11885 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11886 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11887 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11888 transformation rules.
11889
11890 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11891 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11892 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11893 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11894 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11895 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11896 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11897
11898 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11899 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11900 ACL based conditions.
11901
11902 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11903 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11904 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11905 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11906
11907 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11908 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11909 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11910 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11911
11912 Example :
11913 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11914 # last 30 minutes
11915 backend pop
11916 mode tcp
11917 balance roundrobin
11918 stick store-request src
11919 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11920 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11921 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11922
11923 backend smtp
11924 mode tcp
11925 balance roundrobin
11926 stick match src table pop
11927 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11928 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11929
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011930 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11931 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011932
11933
11934stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11935 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11936 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11937 no | no | yes | yes
11938
11939 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11940 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11941 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11942 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11943
11944 Examples :
11945 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011946 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011947
11948 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11949 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11950 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11951
11952
11953 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11954 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11955 backend http
11956 mode http
11957 balance roundrobin
11958 stick on src table https
11959 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11960 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11961 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11962
11963 backend https
11964 mode tcp
11965 balance roundrobin
11966 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11967 stick on src
11968 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11969 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11970
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011971 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011972
11973
11974stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11975 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11977 no | no | yes | yes
11978
11979 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011980 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011981 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011982 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011983 server is selected.
11984
11985 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11986 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11987 the "stick-table" statement.
11988
11989 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11990 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11991 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11992 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11993 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11994 address.
11995
11996 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11997 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11998 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11999 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12000 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12001 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12002 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12003 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12004 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12005 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12006
12007 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12008 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12009 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12010 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12011 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12012 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12013 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12014
12015 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12016 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12017 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12018 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12019
12020 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12021 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12022 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12023 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12024 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12025 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012026 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12027 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12028 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12029 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12030 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12031 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012032
12033 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12034 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12035 the request.
12036
12037 Example :
12038 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12039 # last 30 minutes
12040 backend pop
12041 mode tcp
12042 balance roundrobin
12043 stick store-request src
12044 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12045 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12046 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12047
12048 backend smtp
12049 mode tcp
12050 balance roundrobin
12051 stick match src table pop
12052 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12053 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12054
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012055 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012056
12057
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012058stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012059 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012060 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012061 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012063 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012064
12065 Arguments :
12066 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12067 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12068 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12069 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12070
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012071 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12072 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12073 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12074 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12075
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012076 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12077 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12078 instance.
12079
12080 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12081 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12082 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12083 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12084 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12085 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012086 to 32 characters.
12087
12088 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12089 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12090 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012091 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012092 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12093 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012094
12095 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012096 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12097 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012098 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12099 increase.
12100
12101 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012102 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12103 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12104 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012105
12106 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012107 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012108 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12109 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012110 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012111 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12112 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12113 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12114 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12115 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12116 parameter (see below).
12117
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012118 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12119 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12120 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12121 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12122 soft restart.
12123
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012124 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012125 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12126 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012127 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12128 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012129 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012130 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012131 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12132 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012133 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12134 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012135
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012136 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12137 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12138 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12139 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12140 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12141 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12142 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12143 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12144 token.
12145
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012146 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12147 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12148 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12149 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012150 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12151 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12152 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12153 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12154 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12155 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12156 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12157 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12158 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12159 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12160 types and their arguments.
12161
12162 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12163 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12164 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12165 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12166
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012167 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12168 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12169 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12170 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12171 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12172 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12173 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12174 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12175 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12176 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012177 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12178 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12179 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12180 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012181
12182 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12183 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12184 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12185 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12186 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12187 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012188 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12189 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12190 update message can fit into the buffer.
12191 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12192 store only the counter gpc0.
12193 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012194 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12195 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12196 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012197 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12198 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12199 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12200 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012201
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012202 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12203 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12204 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012205 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012206
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012207 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12208 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12209 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012210 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012211 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012212 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012213
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012214 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12215 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12216 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12217 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12218
12219 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12220 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12221 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12222 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12223 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12224 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12225
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012226 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12227 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12228 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12229 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12230 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012231 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12232 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12233 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12234 to store only the tag gpt0.
12235 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12236 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12237 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012238 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12239 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12240 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012241
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012242 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12243 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12244 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12245 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12246
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012247 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12248 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12249 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12250 they were received.
12251
12252 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12253 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12254 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12255 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12256 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12257
12258 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12259 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12260 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12261 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12262 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12263
12264 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12265 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12266 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12267
12268 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12269 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12270 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12271 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12272 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12273
12274 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12275 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12276 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12277 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12278 the client side.
12279
12280 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12281 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12282 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12283 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12284 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12285 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12286 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12287
12288 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12289 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12290 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12291 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12292 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12293 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012294 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012295
12296 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12297 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12298 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12299 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12300 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12301 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12302
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012303 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12304 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12305 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12306 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12307 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12308
12309 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12310 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12311 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12312 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12313 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12314 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12315
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012316 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012317 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012318 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12319 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12320
12321 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12322 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12323 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12324 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12325 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12326 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12327 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12328 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12329 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12330 recommended for better fairness.
12331
12332 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012333 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012334 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12335 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12336
12337 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12338 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12339 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12340 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12341 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12342 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12343 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12344 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12345 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12346 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012347
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012348 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12349 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012350 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12351 reference it.
12352
12353 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12354 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012355 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12356 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12357 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012358
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012359 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12360 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12361 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12362 something that can be ignored.
12363
12364 Example:
12365 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12366 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12367 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12368 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12369
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012370 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012371 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012372
12373
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012374stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012375 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012376 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12377 no | no | yes | yes
12378
12379 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012380 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012381 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012382 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012383 server is selected.
12384
12385 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12386 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12387 the "stick-table" statement.
12388
12389 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12390 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12391 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12392 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12393
12394 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12395 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12396 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12397 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12398 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12399 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012400 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012401 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12402 rules.
12403
12404 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12405 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12406 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12407 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12408 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12409 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12410 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12411
12412 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12413 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12414 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12415 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12416
12417 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12418 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12419 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12420 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12421 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12422 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012423 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12424 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12425 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12426 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12427 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12428 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12429 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12430 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12431 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012432
12433 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12434
12435 Example :
12436 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12437 backend https
12438 mode tcp
12439 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012440 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012441 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012442
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012443 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
12444 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012445
12446 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12447 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12448 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12449
12450 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12451 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012452
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012453 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12454 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12455 # at offset 44.
12456
12457 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012458 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012459
12460 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012461 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012462
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012463 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12464 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12465
12466 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12467 extraction.
12468
12469
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012470tcp-check comment <string>
12471 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12472 it fails.
12473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12474 yes | no | yes | yes
12475
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012476 Arguments :
12477 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12478 rule fails.
12479
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012480 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12481 user-friendly error reporting.
12482
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012483 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12484 "tcp-check expect".
12485
12486
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012487tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12488 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012489 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012490 Opens a new connection
12491 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012492 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012493
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012494 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012495 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12496
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012497 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012498 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012499
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012500 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012501 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12502 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012503 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012504
12505 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012506
12507 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12508
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012509 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12510
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012511 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12512
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012513 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12514
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012515 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12516 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12517 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12518 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12519
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012520 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12521 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12522 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12523 haproxy -vv.
12524
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012525 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012526
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012527 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12528 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12529 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12530
12531 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12532 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12533 of the sequence.
12534
12535 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12536 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12537 do.
12538
12539 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12540 unset-var or comment rules.
12541
12542 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012543 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12544 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12545 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12546 option tcp-check
12547 tcp-check connect
12548 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12549 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12550 tcp-check send \r\n
12551 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12552 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12553 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12554 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12555 tcp-check send \r\n
12556 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12557 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12558
12559 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12560 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012561 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012562 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12563 tcp-check connect port 143
12564 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12565 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12566
12567 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12568
12569
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012570tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012571 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012572 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012573 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012574 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012575 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012576 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012577
12578 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012579 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12580
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012581 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12582 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12583 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12584 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12585 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12586 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12587 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12588 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12589 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12590 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12591
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012592 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012593 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12594 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012595 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12596 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12597 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12598
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012599 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12600 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12601 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012602 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
12603 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012604 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12605 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012606 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
12607 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012608 By default "L7OK" is used.
12609
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012610 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12611 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010012612 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
12613 supported :
12614 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
12615 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012616 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
12617 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
12618 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
12619 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
12620 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012621
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012622 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012623 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012624 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
12625 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
12626 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
12627 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012628 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
12629
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020012630 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12631 informational message reported in logs if the expect
12632 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
12633 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
12634
12635 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
12636 informational message reported in logs if an error
12637 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
12638 log-format string.
12639
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012640 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
12641 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
12642 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12643 followed by some converters.
12644
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012645 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
12646 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
12647 with the usual backslash ('\').
12648 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012649 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012650 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
12651 used upper or lower case.
12652
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012653 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
12654
12655 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
12656 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12657 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
12658 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12659 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
12660 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
12661 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
12662 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
12663
12664 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
12665 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12666 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
12667 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
12668 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
12669 expression.
12670
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012671 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
12672 A health check response will be considered valid if the
12673 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
12674 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
12675 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12676 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
12677
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012678 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
12679 in the response buffer. A health check response will
12680 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
12681 this exact hexadecimal string.
12682 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
12683
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012684 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
12685 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
12686 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
12687 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
12688 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
12689 size of the original response. As such, the expected
12690 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
12691 size.
12692
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020012693 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
12694 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
12695 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
12696 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
12697 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
12698 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
12699 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
12700 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
12701 in a binary string before matching the response's
12702 buffer.
12703
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012704 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012705 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012706 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
12707 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
12708 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
12709 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
12710 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
12711 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
12712 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
12713 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
12714 the null character.
12715
12716 Examples :
12717 # perform a POP check
12718 option tcp-check
12719 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12720
12721 # perform an IMAP check
12722 option tcp-check
12723 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12724
12725 # look for the redis master server
12726 option tcp-check
12727 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020012728 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012729 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12730 tcp-check expect string role:master
12731 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
12732 tcp-check expect string +OK
12733
12734
12735 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012736 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012737
12738
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012739tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
12740tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
12741 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
12742 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012743 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012744 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012745
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012746 Arguments :
12747 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12748
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012749 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
12750 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012751
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012752 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
12753 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012754
12755 Examples :
12756 # look for the redis master server
12757 option tcp-check
12758 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
12759 tcp-check expect string role:master
12760
12761 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012762 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012763
12764
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012765tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
12766tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
12767 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
12768 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012769 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012770 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012771
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012772 Arguments :
12773 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012774
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012775 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
12776 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020012777
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020012778 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
12779 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
12780 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012781
12782 Examples :
12783 # redis check in binary
12784 option tcp-check
12785 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
12786 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
12787
12788
12789 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010012790 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012791
12792
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012793tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12794tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012795 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012796 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012797 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012798
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012799 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012800 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12801 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12802 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12803 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12804 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12805 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12806 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12807 and '-'.
12808
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012809 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
12810 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050012811 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012812 conditions.
12813
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012814 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
12815
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012816 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
12817 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
12818
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012819 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012820 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012821 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012822
12823
12824tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012825 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012826 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012827 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012828
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012829 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012830 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12831 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12832 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12833 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12834 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12835 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12836 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12837 and '-'.
12838
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012839 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012840 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12841
12842
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012843tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012844 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012846 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012847 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012848 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12849 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012850
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012851 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012852
12853 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12854 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012855 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12856 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12857 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12858 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12859 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12860 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012861
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012862 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12863 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12864 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012865 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12866 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12867 is true.
12868
12869 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12870 supported:
12871 - accept
12872 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12873 - expect-proxy layer4
12874 - reject
12875 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12876 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12877 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12878 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12879 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12880 - set-dst <expr>
12881 - set-dst-port <expr>
12882 - set-mark <mark>
12883 - set-src <expr>
12884 - set-src-port <expr>
12885 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012886 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12887 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010012888 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012889 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12890 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12891 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012892 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012893
12894 The supported actions are described below.
12895
12896 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12897 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012898
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012899 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12900 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12901 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12902 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12903 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12904 a defaults section defining such rules.
12905
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012906 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12907 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12908 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012909
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012910 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12911 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12912 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012913
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012914 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12915 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12916 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012917
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012918 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12919 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12920 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012921
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012922 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12923 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12924 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012925
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012926 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012927
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012928 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012929
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012930 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012931
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012932 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012933
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012934tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012935
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012936 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12937 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012938
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012939tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12940 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012941
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012942 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12943 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12944 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12945 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12946 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12947 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12948 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012949
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012950tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012951
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012952 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12953 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12954 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12955 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12956 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12957 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012958
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012959tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012960
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012961 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12962 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12963 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12964 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12965 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12966 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12967 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12968 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12969 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12970 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12971 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012972
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012973tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12974tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12975tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012976
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012977 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12978 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12979 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12980 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012981
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012982tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12983 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12984tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12985 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012986
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012987 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12988 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12989 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012990
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012991tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12992tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012993
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012994 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12995 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12996 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012997
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012998tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012999
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013000 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13001 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13002 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013003
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013004tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13005tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013006
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013007 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13008 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13009 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013010
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013011tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013012
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013013 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13014 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13015 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013016
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013017tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13018tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013019
13020 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13021 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13022 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13023 for a complete description.
13024
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013025tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013026
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013027 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13028 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13029 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13030 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013031
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013032tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13033tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13034tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013035
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013036 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13037 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13038 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013039
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013040tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13041
13042 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13043 details about variables.
13044
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013045
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013046tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13047 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013048 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013049 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013050 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013051 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13052 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013054 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013055
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013056 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013057 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13058 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013059 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13060 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013061
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013062 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13063 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13064 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13065 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013066 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013067 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013068 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13069 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13070 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13071 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013072 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013073 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013074
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013075 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13076 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13077 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13078 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013079
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013080 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13081 supported:
13082 - accept
13083 - capture <sample> len <length>
13084 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13085 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013086 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013087 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013088 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013089 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013090 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013091 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013092 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013093 - set-dst <expr>
13094 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013095 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013096 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013097 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013098 - set-priority-class <expr>
13099 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013100 - set-src <expr>
13101 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013102 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013103 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13104 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013105 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013106 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013107 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13108 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13109 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013110 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013111 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013112
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013113 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013114
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013115 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13116 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13117 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13118 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13119 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13120 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013121
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013122 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13123 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13124 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13125 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13126 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13127 a defaults section defining such rules.
13128
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013129 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013130 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13131 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013132
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013133 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13134 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13135 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13136 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13137 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13138 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13139
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013140 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013141 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13142 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13143 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13144 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13145 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13146 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13147 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13148 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13149 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13150 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013151
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013152 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013153 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13154 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13155 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013156
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013157 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013158 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013159
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013160 Example:
13161
13162 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013163 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013164 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013165
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013166 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013167 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013168 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013169 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13170 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013171 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013172 tcp-request content reject
13173
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013174 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13175 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13176 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13177 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13178 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13179 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13180 ...
13181 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13182
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013183 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013184 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13185 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013186 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013187 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013188
13189 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13190 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013191 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013192 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013193 tcp-request content reject
13194
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013195 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013196 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013197 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013198 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013199 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13200 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013201
13202 Example:
13203 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13204 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013205 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013206
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013207 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013208 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013209
13210 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013211 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013212 # protecting all our sites
13213 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013214 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13215 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013216 ...
13217 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13218
13219 backend http_dynamic
13220 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013221 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013222 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013223 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013224 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013225 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013226 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013228 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013229
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013230 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13231 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013232
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013233tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13234
13235 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013236 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013237
13238tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13239 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13240
13241 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13242 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13243 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13244 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13245 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13246 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13247 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13248 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13249 information.
13250
13251tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13252
13253 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13254 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13255 complete description.
13256
13257tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13258
13259 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13260 are evaluated.
13261
13262tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13263tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13264tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13265
13266 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13267 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13268 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13269 description.
13270
13271tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13272 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13273tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13274 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13275
13276 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13277 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13278 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
13279
13280tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13281 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13282
13283 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13284 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13285
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013286tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13287 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013288
13289 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13290 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13291 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13292
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013293tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13294tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13295
13296 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13297 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13298 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13299
13300tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13301
13302 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13303 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13304
13305tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13306
13307 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13308 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13309 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13310
13311tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13312
13313 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13314 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13315
13316tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13317
13318 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13319 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13320
13321tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13322
13323 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13324 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13325 description.
13326
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013327tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13328tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13329
13330 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13331 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13332 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13333
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013334tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13335
13336 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13337 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13338 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13339
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013340tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13341tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013342
13343 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13344 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13345 for a complete description.
13346
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013347tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013348
13349 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13350 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13351 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13352 complete description.
13353
13354tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13355 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13356
13357 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13358 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13359 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13360 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13361 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13362 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13363 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13364 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13365 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13366 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13367
13368 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13369
13370tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13371tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13372tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13373
13374 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13375 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13376 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13377
13378tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13379
13380 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13381 details about variables.
13382
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013383tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013384
13385 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13386 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13387 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13388 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13389 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13390
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013391
13392tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13393 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013395 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013396 Arguments :
13397 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13398 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13399 as explained at the top of this document.
13400
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013401 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013402 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13403 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13404 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13405 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13406
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013407 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13408 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13409 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13410 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13411
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013412 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013413 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013414 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013415 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013416 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013417 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13418 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13419 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013420
13421 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13422 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13423 it pass through unaffected.
13424
13425 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13426 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13427 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013428 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013429 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13430 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013431 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13432 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13433 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013434
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013435 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13436 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13437
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013438 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013439 "timeout client".
13440
13441
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013442tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13443 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013445 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013446 Arguments :
13447 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13448 below.
13449
13450 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13451
13452 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13453 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13454 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13455 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013456 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013457 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13458 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13459 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13460 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13461 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13462 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13463 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13464 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13465 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13466 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13467 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13468 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13469 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13470 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13471 instead.
13472
13473 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13474 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13475 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13476 rules which may be inserted.
13477
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013478 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13479 supported:
13480 - accept
13481 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013482 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13483 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13484 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13485 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13486 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013487 - set-dst <expr>
13488 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013489 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013490 - set-src <expr>
13491 - set-src-port <expr>
13492 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013493 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13494 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013495 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013496 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13497 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13498 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13499 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013500
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013501 The supported actions are described below.
13502
13503 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13504 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13505 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13506 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13507 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13508 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013509
13510 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13511 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13512 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13513
13514 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13515 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13516 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13517 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13518 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13519
13520 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13521 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13522
13523 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13524 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13525 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13526
13527 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13528 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13529 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13530
13531 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13532 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13533 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13534
13535 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13536 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13537 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13538
13539 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13540
13541 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13542
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013543tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13544
13545 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13546 rules are evaluated.
13547
13548tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13549
13550 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13551 are evaluated.
13552
13553tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13554tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13555tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13556
13557 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13558 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13559 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13560 description.
13561
13562tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13563 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13564tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13565 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13566
13567 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13568 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
13569 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
13570 description.
13571
13572tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13573tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13574
13575 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13576 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13577 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13578
13579tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13580
13581 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13582 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13583 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13584
13585tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13586tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13587
13588 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13589 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13590 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13591
13592tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13593
13594 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13595 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13596 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13597
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013598tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13599tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013600
13601 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13602 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13603 for a complete description.
13604
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013605tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013606
13607 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13608 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13609 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13610 complete description.
13611
13612tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13613tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13614tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13615
13616 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13617 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13618 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13619
13620tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13621
13622 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13623 details about variables.
13624
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013625
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013626tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13627 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
13628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013629 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013630 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013631 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13632 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013633
13634 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13635
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013636 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013637 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13638 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013639 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
13640 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013641
13642 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
13643
13644 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13645 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13646 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13647 inserted.
13648
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013649 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13650 supported:
13651 - accept
13652 - close
13653 - reject
13654 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13655 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13656 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13657 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13658 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13659 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013660 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013661 - set-log-level <level>
13662 - set-mark <mark>
13663 - set-nice <nice>
13664 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013665 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
13666 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013667 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013668 - unset-var(<var-name>)
13669
13670 The supported actions are described below.
13671
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013672 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13673 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13674 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13675 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13676 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13677 a defaults section defining such rules.
13678
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013679 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13680 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13681 for changing the default action to a reject.
13682
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013683 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013684
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013685 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
13686 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
13687 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
13688 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
13689 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020013690
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013691 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013692
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013693 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013694
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013695tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013696
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013697 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13698 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013699
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013700tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013701
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013702 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
13703 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
13704 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
13705 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
13706 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
13707 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013708
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013709tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013710
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013711 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
13712 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013713
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013714tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13715tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13716tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013717
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013718 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13719 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13720 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13721 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013722
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013723tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13724 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13725tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13726 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013727
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013728 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13729 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
13730 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013731
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013732tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13733 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013734
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013735 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
13736 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013737
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013738
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013739tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13740 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013741
13742 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13743 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13744 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13745
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013746tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013747
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013748 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13749 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013750
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013751tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013752
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013753 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13754 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13755 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013756
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013757tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013758
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013759 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13760 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013761
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013762tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013763
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013764 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13765 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13766 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013767
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013768tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13769tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013770
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013771 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13772 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13773 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013774
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013775tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020013776
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013777 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13778 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13779 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13780 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013781
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013782tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013783
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013784 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13785 details about variables.
13786
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013787
13788tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
13789 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
13790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013791 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013792 Arguments :
13793 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13794 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13795 as explained at the top of this document.
13796
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013797 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13798 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013799
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020013800 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
13801
13802
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013803timeout check <timeout>
13804 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
13805 established.
13806
13807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13808 yes | no | yes | yes
13809 Arguments:
13810 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13811 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13812 as explained at the top of this document.
13813
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013814 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013815 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013816 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013817 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010013818 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
13819 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
13820 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013821
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013822 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013823 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
13824
13825 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
13826 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013827 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013828
13829 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13830 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13831 forget about it.
13832
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013833 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13834 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13835
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010013836 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
13837 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013838
13839
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013840timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013841 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
13842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13843 yes | yes | yes | no
13844 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013845 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013846 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13847 as explained at the top of this document.
13848
13849 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13850 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13851 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013852 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13853 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13854 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13855 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013856 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13857 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13858 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013859 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013860 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013861 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13862 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013863 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13864 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013865
13866 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13867 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13868 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13869 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013870 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013871 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13872
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013873 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013875
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013876timeout client-fin <timeout>
13877 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13879 yes | yes | yes | no
13880 Arguments :
13881 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13882 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13883 as explained at the top of this document.
13884
13885 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13886 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13887 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13888 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13889 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13890 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13891 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013892 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13893 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13894 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013895
13896 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13897 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13898 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13899
13900 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13901
13902
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013903timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013904 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13906 yes | no | yes | yes
13907 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013908 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013909 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13910 as explained at the top of this document.
13911
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013912 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013913 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013914 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013915 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013916 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13917 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013918
13919 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13920 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13921 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13922 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013923 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013924 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13925
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013926 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013927
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013928
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013929timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13930 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13932 yes | yes | yes | yes
13933 Arguments :
13934 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13935 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13936 as explained at the top of this document.
13937
13938 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13939 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13940 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13941 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13942 once the request has started to present itself.
13943
13944 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13945 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13946 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13947 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13948 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13949
13950 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13951 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13952 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13953 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13954
13955 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13956 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013957 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013958 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13959 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013960 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013961
13962 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13963 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13964 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13965 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13966
13967 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13968
13969
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013970timeout http-request <timeout>
13971 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013973 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013974 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013975 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013976 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13977 as explained at the top of this document.
13978
13979 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13980 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13981 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13982 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13983 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13984 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13985 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013986 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13987 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13988 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13989 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013990 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013991 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13992 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013993
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013994 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13995 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13996 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13997 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13998 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013999 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014000
14001 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14002 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014003 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014004 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14005 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14006
14007 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014008 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14009 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14010 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014011
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014012 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014013 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014014
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014015
14016timeout queue <timeout>
14017 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14019 yes | no | yes | yes
14020 Arguments :
14021 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14022 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14023 as explained at the top of this document.
14024
14025 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14026 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14027 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14028 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14029 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14030
14031 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14032 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14033 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14034 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14035
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014036 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014037
14038
14039timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014040 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14042 yes | no | yes | yes
14043 Arguments :
14044 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14045 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14046 as explained at the top of this document.
14047
14048 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14049 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14050 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14051 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14052 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14053 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14054 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14055
14056 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14057 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14058 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14059 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14060 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014061 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014062 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014063 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14064 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014065 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14066 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014067
14068 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14069 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14070 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14071 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014072 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014073 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14074
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014075 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014076
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014077
14078timeout server-fin <timeout>
14079 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14081 yes | no | yes | yes
14082 Arguments :
14083 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14084 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14085 as explained at the top of this document.
14086
14087 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14088 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14089 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14090 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14091 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14092 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14093 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14094 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14095 situations, it should not be needed.
14096
14097 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14098 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14099 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14100
14101 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14102
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014103
14104timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014105 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014106 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14107 yes | yes | yes | yes
14108 Arguments :
14109 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14110 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14111 as explained at the top of this document.
14112
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014113 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14114 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14115 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014116
14117 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14118 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14119 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14120 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014121 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014122
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014123 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014124
14125
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014126timeout tunnel <timeout>
14127 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14129 yes | no | yes | yes
14130 Arguments :
14131 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14132 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14133 as explained at the top of this document.
14134
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014135 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014136 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14137 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14138 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014139 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14140 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014141 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14142 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14143 specified.
14144
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014145 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14146 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14147 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14148 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14149 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14150 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14151 state.
14152
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014153 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14154 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14155 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14156 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014157 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014158
14159 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14160 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14161 forget about it.
14162
14163 Example :
14164 defaults http
14165 option http-server-close
14166 timeout connect 5s
14167 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014168 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014169 timeout server 30s
14170 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14171
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014172 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014173
14174
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014175transparent (deprecated)
14176 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014178 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014179 Arguments : none
14180
14181 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14182 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14183 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14184 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14185 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14186 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14187 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14188 appropriate server.
14189
14190 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14191
14192 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14193 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14194
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014195 See also: "option transparent"
14196
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014197unique-id-format <string>
14198 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14199 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14200 yes | yes | yes | no
14201 Arguments :
14202 <string> is a log-format string.
14203
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014204 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14205 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14206 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14207 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014208
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014209 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014210 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014211 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14212 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14213 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14214 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14215 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14216 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014217
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014218 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14219 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014220
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014221 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014222
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014223 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014224
14225 will generate:
14226
14227 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14228
14229 See also: "unique-id-header"
14230
14231unique-id-header <name>
14232 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14234 yes | yes | yes | no
14235 Arguments :
14236 <name> is the name of the header.
14237
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014238 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14239 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014240
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014241 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014242
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014243 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014244 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14245
14246 will generate:
14247
14248 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14249
14250 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014251
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014252use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014253 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014254 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14255 no | yes | yes | no
14256 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014257 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14258 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014259
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014260 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14261 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014262
14263 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14264 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14265 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014266 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014267 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014268 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14269 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014270
14271 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14272 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14273 assign the backend.
14274
14275 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14276 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14277 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14278 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14279 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14280 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14281
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014282 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014283 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014284 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14285 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14286 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14287
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014288 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14289 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14290 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14291 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14292 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14293 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14294 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14295 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14296 cannot be forced from the request.
14297
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014298 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014299 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14300 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14301
14302 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14303 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014304
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014305use-fcgi-app <name>
14306 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14308 no | no | yes | yes
14309 Arguments :
14310 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14311
14312 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014313
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014314use-server <server> if <condition>
14315use-server <server> unless <condition>
14316 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14317 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14318 no | no | yes | yes
14319 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014320 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14321 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014322
14323 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14324
14325 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14326 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14327 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14328
14329 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14330 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14331 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14332 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14333 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14334 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14335 matches will assign the server.
14336
14337 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14338 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14339 with the next rules until one matches.
14340
14341 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14342 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14343 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14344 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14345
14346 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14347 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14348 stripped.
14349
14350 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14351 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014352 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014353 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014354 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014355
14356 Example :
14357 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014358 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014359 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014360 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014361 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014362 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014363 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014364 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14365 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14366
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014367 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14368 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14369 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14370 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014371 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014372 and we fall back to load balancing.
14373
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014374 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014375
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014376
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100143775. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014378--------------------------
14379
14380The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14381depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14382settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14383written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14384described in this section.
14385
14386
143875.1. Bind options
14388-----------------
14389
14390The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14391as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14392no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14393parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14394while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14395provided immediately after the setting name.
14396
14397The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14398
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014399accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14400 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14401 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14402 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14403 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14404 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14405 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14406 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14407 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14408 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014409 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14410 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14411 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014412
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014413accept-proxy
14414 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014415 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14416 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014417 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14418 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14419 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14420 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014421 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014422 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14423 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014424 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14425 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014426
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014427allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014428 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014429 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014430 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014431 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14432 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014433
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014434alpn <protocols>
14435 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14436 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14437 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014438 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014439 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014440 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
14441 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14442 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
14443 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
14444 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
14445 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
14446 preference, like below :
14447
14448 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014449
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014450 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14451 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
14452
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014453backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014454 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014455 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14456
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014457curves <curves>
14458 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14459 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14460 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14461 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14462 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14463 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14464
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014465ecdhe <named curve>
14466 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014467 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14468 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014469
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014470ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014471 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14472 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014473 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14474 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014475 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014476
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014477 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14478 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14479 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14480 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14481 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014482 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014483
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014484ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14485 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14486 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014487 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14488 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14489 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14490 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14491 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014492 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14493 error is ignored.
14494
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014495ca-sign-file <cafile>
14496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14497 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14498 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14499 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14500 'generate-certificates' for details.
14501
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014502ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014503 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14504 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14505 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14506 'generate-certificates' for details.
14507
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014508ca-verify-file <cafile>
14509 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14510 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14511 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14512 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14513 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14514
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014515ciphers <ciphers>
14516 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14517 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014518 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014519 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014520 information and recommendations see e.g.
14521 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14522 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14523 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14524
14525ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14526 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14527 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14528 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14529 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014530 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14531 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014532
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014533crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014534 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14535 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014536 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14537 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014538
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014539crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14541 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14542 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14543 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14544 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014545 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14546 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014547
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014548 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14549 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14550
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014551 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14552 are loaded.
14553
14554 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010014555 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020014556 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
14557 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
14558 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
14559 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
14560 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
14561 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
14562 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
14563 www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014564
14565 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
14566 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
14567 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
14568 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010014569 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
14570 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014571
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020014572 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014573
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014574 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014575 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014576 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
14577 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014578 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
14579 clients).
14580
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014581 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020014582 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
14583 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
14584 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
14585 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
14586 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
14587 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
14588 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
14589 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
14590 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
14591 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
14592 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
14593 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
14594
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014595 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010014596 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
14597 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
14598 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
14599 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
14600
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050014601 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
14602 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
14603 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
14604 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014605
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014606 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
14607 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
14608 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014609
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014610crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014612 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
14613 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14614 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14615 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14616 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14617 in new version of OpenSSL.
14618 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14619 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014620
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014621crt-list <file>
14622 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014623 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
14624 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014625
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014626 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
14627
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020014628 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
14629 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
14630 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
14631 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
14632 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014633
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014634 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014635 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
14636 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
14637 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
14638 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
14639 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020014640 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
14641 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
14642 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010014643
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020014644 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
14645 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
14646 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050014647
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014648 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
14649
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014650 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014651 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030014652 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
14653 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
14654 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
14655 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
14656 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
14657 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014658
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014659 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030014660 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020014661 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014662 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014663 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010014664 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010014665
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014666defer-accept
14667 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14668 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
14669 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014670 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014671 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
14672 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
14673 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
14674 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
14675 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
14676 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
14677 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
14678
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014679expose-fd listeners
14680 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
14681 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010014682 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
14683 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014684 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020014685
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014686force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014687 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014688 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014689 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014690 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014691
14692force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014693 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014694 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014695 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014696
14697force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014698 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014699 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014700 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014701
14702force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014703 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014704 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014705 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014706
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014707force-tlsv13
14708 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
14709 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014710 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014711
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014712generate-certificates
14713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14714 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
14715 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
14716 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
14717 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
14718 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
14719 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
14720 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
14721 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
14722 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
14723 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
14724
14725 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
14726 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014727 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014728 certificate is used many times.
14729
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014730gid <gid>
14731 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
14732 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14733 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
14734 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
14735 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14736
14737group <group>
14738 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
14739 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
14740 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
14741 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
14742 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14743
14744id <id>
14745 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
14746 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
14747 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
14748 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
14749
14750interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010014751 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
14752 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
14753 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
14754 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
14755 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
14756 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010014757 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
14758 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
14759 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
14760 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
14761 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
14762 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014763
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014764level <level>
14765 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
14766 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
14767 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014768 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014769 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
14770 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
14771 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014772 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014773 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014774 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020014775 all counters).
14776
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020014777severity-output <format>
14778 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
14779 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
14780 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
14781 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
14782 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
14783 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
14784 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
14785 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
14786 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
14787 rfc5424 convention.
14788
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014789maxconn <maxconn>
14790 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
14791 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
14792 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
14793 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
14794 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
14795 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
14796 eat all memory.
14797
14798mode <mode>
14799 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
14800 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
14801 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
14802 UNIX sockets.
14803
14804mss <maxseg>
14805 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
14806 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
14807 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
14808 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
14809 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
14810 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
14811 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
14812 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
14813 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
14814 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
14815 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
14816
14817name <name>
14818 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
14819 page.
14820
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014821namespace <name>
14822 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14823 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
14824 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14825 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14826
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014827nice <nice>
14828 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
14829 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
14830 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
14831 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
14832 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
14833 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
14834 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
14835 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
14836 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
14837 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
14838 one for an RDP socket.
14839
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014840no-ca-names
14841 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14842 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014843 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020014844
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014845no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014847 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014848 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014849 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014850 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
14851 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014852
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014853no-tls-tickets
14854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14855 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14856 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014857 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
14858 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014859 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14860 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14861 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020014862
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014863no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014864 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014865 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014866 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014867 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014868 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14869 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014870
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014871no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014873 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014874 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014875 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014876 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14877 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014878
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014879no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014881 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014882 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014883 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014884 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14885 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014886
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014887no-tlsv13
14888 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14889 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14890 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14891 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014892 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14893 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014894
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014895npn <protocols>
14896 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14897 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14898 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014899 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014900 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014901 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14902 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14903 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14904 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14905 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014906
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010014907ocsp-update [ off | on ]
14908 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
14909 Its value defaults to 'off'.
14910 This option can only be used in a crt-list line so that is applies to only
14911 one certificate at a time. If a given certificate is used in multiple
14912 crt-lists with different values of the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be
14913 raised.
14914 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
14915 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
14916 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
14917 the OCSP certid to be built.
14918 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
14919 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
14920 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
14921 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
14922 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
14923 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
14924 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
14925 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
14926 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
14927 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
14928 short time after init.
14929 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
14930 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
14931 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
14932
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014933prefer-client-ciphers
14934 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14935 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14936 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014937 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14938 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14939 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014940
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014941proto <name>
14942 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14943 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14944 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014945 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14946 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14947
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014948 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
14949 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
14950 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014951
14952 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14953 a bind line :
14954
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020014955 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014956 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14957 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14958
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014959 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014960 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014961 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014962 h2" on the bind line.
14963
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020014964quic-cc-algo [ cubic | newreno ]
14965 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14966
14967 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
14968 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
14969 to those used by TCP.
14970
14971 Default value: cubic
14972
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014973quic-force-retry
14974 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
14975 change without deprecation in the future.
14976
14977 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
14978 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
14979 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
14980 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
14981 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
14982 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
14983 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010014984 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
14985
14986 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
14987 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020014988
14989 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
14990 information about QUIC retry.
14991
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014992shards <number> | by-thread
14993 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14994 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14995 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14996 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14997 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14998 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14999 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15000 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15001 little bit.
15002
15003 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15004 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15005 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15006 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15007 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
15008 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
15009
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015010ssl
15011 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015012 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015013 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15014 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015015 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15016 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015017
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015018ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15019 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015020 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15021 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15022 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015023 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15024
15025ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015026 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15027 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15028 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15029 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015030
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015031strict-sni
15032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15033 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
15034 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
15035 See the "crt" option for more information.
15036
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015037tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015038 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015039 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015040 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015041 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015042 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15043 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15044 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15045 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15046 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15047 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15048 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15049
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015050tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015051 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015052 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15053 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15054 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15055 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15056 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15057 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15058 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015059 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15060 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15061 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015062
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015063thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015064 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15065 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15066 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015067
15068 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15069 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015070 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15071 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15072 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15073 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15074 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15075 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15076 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15077 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015078
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015079 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15080 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015081
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015082 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15083
15084 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15085 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15086 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15087 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15088 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15089 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15090 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
15091 or absolute dependeing on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
15092 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15093 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15094 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15095 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15096
15097 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15098 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15099 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15100 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15101 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15102 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015103
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015104 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15105 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15106 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15107 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015108
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015109tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15110 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015111 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15112 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15113 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15114 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15115 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15116 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15117 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15118 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15119 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15120 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015121 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15122 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15123
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015124transparent
15125 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15126 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15127 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15128 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15129 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15130 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15131 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15132 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15133 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15134 so check for support with your vendor.
15135
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015136v4v6
15137 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15138 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15139 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15140 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015141 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015142
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015143v6only
15144 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15145 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15146 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015147 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15148 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015149
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015150uid <uid>
15151 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15152 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15153 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15154 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15155 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15156
15157user <user>
15158 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15159 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15160 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15161 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15162 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15163
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015164verify [none|optional|required]
15165 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15166 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15167 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15168 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15169 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015170 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15171 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15172 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15173 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015174
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200151755.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015176------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015177
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015178The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15179which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15180arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15181settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15182after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15183Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15184address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015185
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015186 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015187 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015188
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015189Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15190keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15191
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015192The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015193
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015194addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015195 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015196 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15197 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15198 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15199 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15200 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015201
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015202agent-check
15203 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015204 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015205 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15206 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15207 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015208
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015209 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015210 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015211 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015212 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15213 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015214
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015215 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15216 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15217 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15218 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15219 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015220
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015221 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015222 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015223
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015224 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15225 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15226 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015227
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015228 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15229 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15230 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015231
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015232 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015233 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15234 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15235 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15236 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015237 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015238 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015239
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015240 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15241 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015242
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015243 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15244 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15245 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15246 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15247 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15248 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15249 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15250 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15251 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015252
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015253 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15254 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015255 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15256 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15257 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015258 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015259
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015260 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015261 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015262
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015263agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015264 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015265 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15266 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15267 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15268 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15269
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015270agent-inter <delay>
15271 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15272 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15273
15274 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15275 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15276 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15277 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15278 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15279 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15280 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15281 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15282 of backends use the same servers.
15283
15284 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15285
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015286agent-addr <addr>
15287 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15288
15289 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015290 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015291 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15292 hostname, it will be resolved.
15293
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015294agent-port <port>
15295 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15296
15297 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15298
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015299allow-0rtt
15300 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015301 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15302 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015303
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015304alpn <protocols>
15305 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15306 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15307 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015308 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015309 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15310 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15311 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15312 now obsolete NPN extension.
15313 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15314 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15315
15316 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15317
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015318 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015320backup
15321 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15322 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15323 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15324 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015325 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15326 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015327
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015328ca-file <cafile>
15329 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15330 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015331 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15332 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015333 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015334
15335 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15336 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15337 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015338
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015339check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015340 This option enables health checks on a server:
15341 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15342 considered available.
15343 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15344 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15345 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15346 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15347 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015348 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15349 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015350 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15351 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15352 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15353 exchanges succeed.
15354
15355 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15356 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15357 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15358 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15359 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015360 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015361 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15362
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015363 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015364 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015365 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15366 not overridden.
15367
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015368 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15369 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15370
15371 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15372 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15373
15374 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15375 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15376 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15377 available.
15378
15379 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15380 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15381 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15382
15383 Example:
15384 # simple tcp check
15385 backend foo
15386 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15387 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15388 backend foo
15389 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15390 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15391 backend foo
15392 option tcp-check
15393 tcp-check connect
15394 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015395
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015396check-send-proxy
15397 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15398 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15399 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15400 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15401 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15402 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15403 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15404
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015405check-alpn <protocols>
15406 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
15407 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
15408 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
15409
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015410check-proto <name>
15411 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
15412 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
15413 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015414 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
15415 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15416
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015417 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15418 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15419 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015420
15421 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
15422 directive on a server line:
15423
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015424 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015425 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15426 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15427 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15428
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015429 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015430 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
15431 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
15432
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015433check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015434 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015435 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
15436 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015437
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015438check-ssl
15439 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
15440 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
15441 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
15442 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015443 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015444 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
15445 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015446 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015447 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
15448 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015449
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015450check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015451 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015452 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
15453 for normal traffic.
15454
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015455ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015456 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
15457 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
15458 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015459 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
15460 information and recommendations see e.g.
15461 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
15462 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
15463 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015464
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015465ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
15466 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
15467 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
15468 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
15469 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000015470 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
15471 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
15472 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020015473
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015474cookie <value>
15475 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
15476 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
15477 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
15478 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
15479 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
15480 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
15481 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
15482
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015483crl-file <crlfile>
15484 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15485 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
15486 to verify server's certificate.
15487
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020015488crt <cert>
15489 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
15490 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
15491 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
15492 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
15493 certificate request.
15494
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020015495 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
15496 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
15497 option is set accordingly).
15498
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015499disabled
15500 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
15501 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
15502 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
15503 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
15504 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015505 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015506
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015507enabled
15508 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
15509 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
15510 default value.
15511 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
15512 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020015513
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015514error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010015515 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
15516 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
15517 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015519 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015520
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015521fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015522 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
15523 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
15524 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
15525
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015526force-sslv3
15527 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15528 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015529 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015530 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015531
15532force-tlsv10
15533 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015534 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015535 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015536
15537force-tlsv11
15538 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015539 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015540 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015541
15542force-tlsv12
15543 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015544 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015545 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015546
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015547force-tlsv13
15548 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
15549 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015550 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015551
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015552id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020015553 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
15554 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
15555 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015556
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015557init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
15558 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
15559 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015560 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015561 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
15562 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
15563 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
15564 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
15565 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
15566 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
15567 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
15568 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
15569 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015570 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015571 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
15572 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
15573 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
15574 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
15575 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
15576 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015577 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010015578
15579 Example:
15580 defaults
15581 # never fail on address resolution
15582 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
15583
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015584inter <delay>
15585fastinter <delay>
15586downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015587 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
15588 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15589 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
15590 between checks depending on the server state :
15591
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020015592 Server state | Interval used
15593 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15594 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
15595 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15596 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
15597 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
15598 or yet unchecked. |
15599 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
15600 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
15601 | "inter" otherwise.
15602 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015603
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015604 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
15605 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
15606 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
15607 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015608 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15609 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15610 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15611 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15612 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015613
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020015614log-proto <logproto>
15615 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
15616 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
15617 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
15618 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
15619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015620maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015621 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
15622 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015623 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
15624 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015625 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
15626 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
15627 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
15628 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
15629
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010015630 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
15631 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
15632 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
15633 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
15634 than 50 concurrent requests.
15635
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015636maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015637 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
15638 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
15639 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
15640 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020015641 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
15642 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
15643 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
15644 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
15645 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
15646 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
15647 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015648
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010015649max-reuse <count>
15650 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
15651 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
15652 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
15653 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
15654 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
15655 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
15656 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
15657 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
15658
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015659minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015660 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
15661 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
15662 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
15663 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
15664 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
15665 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015666 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015667 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015668
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015669namespace <name>
15670 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15671 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
15672 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15673 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15674
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015675no-agent-check
15676 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
15677 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15678 default value.
15679 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15680 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
15681
15682no-backup
15683 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
15684 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15685 default value.
15686 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15687 "default-server" "backup" setting.
15688
15689no-check
15690 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
15691 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15692 default value.
15693 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15694 "default-server" "check" setting.
15695
15696no-check-ssl
15697 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
15698 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15699 default value.
15700 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15701 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
15702
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015703no-send-proxy
15704 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
15705 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15706 default value.
15707 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15708 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
15709
15710no-send-proxy-v2
15711 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
15712 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15713 default value.
15714 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15715 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
15716
15717no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
15718 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
15719 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15720 default value.
15721 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15722 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
15723
15724no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15725 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
15726 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15727 default value.
15728 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15729 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
15730
15731no-ssl
15732 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
15733 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15734 default value.
15735 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15736 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
15737
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010015738 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
15739 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
15740 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
15741
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010015742no-ssl-reuse
15743 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
15744 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
15745 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
15746 and for paranoid users.
15747
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015748no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015749 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15750 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015751 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015752
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015753 Supported in default-server: No
15754
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015755no-tls-tickets
15756 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15757 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15758 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015759 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
15760 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015761 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15762 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15763 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015764 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020015765
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015766no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015767 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015768 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15769 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015770 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15771 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015772 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015773
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015774 Supported in default-server: No
15775
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015776no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015777 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015778 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15779 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015780 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15781 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015782 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015783
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015784 Supported in default-server: No
15785
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015786no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020015787 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015788 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15789 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015790 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15791 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015792 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015793
15794 Supported in default-server: No
15795
15796no-tlsv13
15797 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
15798 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
15799 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
15800 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
15801 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015802 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015803
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020015804 Supported in default-server: No
15805
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015806no-verifyhost
15807 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
15808 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15809 default value.
15810 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15811 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015812
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015813no-tfo
15814 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
15815 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15816 default value.
15817 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15818 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
15819
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090015820non-stick
15821 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
15822 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
15823 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
15824
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015825npn <protocols>
15826 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15827 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15828 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015829 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015830 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
15831 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15832 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
15833
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015834observe <mode>
15835 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
15836 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
15837 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
15838 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
15839 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
15840 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010015841 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015842
15843 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
15844
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015845on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010015846 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
15847 Currently, four modes are available:
15848 - fastinter: force fastinter
15849 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
15850 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
15851 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
15852 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
15853
15854 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
15855
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015856on-marked-down <action>
15857 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
15858 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015859 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
15860 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
15861 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
15862 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
15863 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
15864 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
15865 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
15866 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090015867
15868 Actions are disabled by default
15869
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015870on-marked-up <action>
15871 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
15872 Currently one action is available:
15873 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
15874 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
15875 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
15876 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015877 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
15878 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015879 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
15880 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
15881
15882 Actions are disabled by default
15883
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015884pool-low-conn <max>
15885 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
15886 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
15887 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
15888 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
15889 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
15890 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
15891 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
15892 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
15893 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
15894 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010015895 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
15896 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
15897 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
15898 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020015899
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010015900pool-max-conn <max>
15901 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
15902 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
15903 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
15904 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
15905 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
15906 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
15907
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015908pool-purge-delay <delay>
15909 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010015910 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020015911 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010015912
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015913port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015914 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010015915 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15916 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
15917 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
15918 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
15919 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015920
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015921proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015922 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
15923 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
15924 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015925 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
15926 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15927
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015928 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15929 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15930 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015931
15932 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15933 a server line :
15934
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015935 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015936 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15937 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15938 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15939
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015940 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015941 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15942
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015943 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015945redir <prefix>
15946 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15947 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15948 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15949 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15950 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15951 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15952 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15953 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015954 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015955 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015956 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15957 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15958 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15959 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15960
15961 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15962
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015963rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015964 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15965 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15966 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15967
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015968resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15969 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15970 server.
15971
15972 Available options:
15973
15974 * allow-dup-ip
15975 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15976 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15977 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15978 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15979 For such case, simply enable this option.
15980 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15981
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015982 * ignore-weight
15983 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15984 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15985 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15986
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015987 * prevent-dup-ip
15988 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15989 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15990 same fqdn.
15991 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15992
15993 Example:
15994 backend b_myapp
15995 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15996 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15997 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15998
15999 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16000 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16001 it
16002 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16003 different address
16004
16005 Default value: not set
16006
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016007resolve-prefer <family>
16008 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16009 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16010 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16011 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16012
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016013 Default value: ipv6
16014
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016015 Example:
16016
16017 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016018
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016019resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016020 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016021 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016022 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016023 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16024 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016025 configured network, another address is selected.
16026
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016027 Example:
16028
16029 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016030
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016031resolvers <id>
16032 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16033 hostname.
16034
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016035 Example:
16036
16037 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016038
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016039 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016040
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016041send-proxy
16042 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16043 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16044 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16045 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016046 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16047 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16048 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16049 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016050 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016051 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16052 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16053 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16054 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16055 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016056 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16057 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016058
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016059send-proxy-v2
16060 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16061 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16062 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16063 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016064 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16065 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16066 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16067 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016068
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016069proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016070 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16071 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16072
16073 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16074 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16075 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16076 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16077 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16078 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16079 connection is supported).
16080 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16081 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16082 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16083 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16084 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16085 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16086 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016087
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016088send-proxy-v2-ssl
16089 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16090 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16091 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16092 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16093 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16094 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16095 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016096 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16097 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016098
16099send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16100 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16101 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16102 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16103 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16104 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16105 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16106 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16107 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016108 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16109 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016110
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016111shard <shard>
16112 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16113 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16114 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16115 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16116 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16117 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16118 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16119
16120 Example :
16121
16122 peers mypeers
16123 shards 3
16124 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16125 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16126 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16127 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16128
16129
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016130slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016131 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16132 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16133 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16134 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16135 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16136 parameters :
16137
16138 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16139 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16140
16141 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16142 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16143 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16144 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16145
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016146 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016147 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16148 seen as failed.
16149
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016150sni <expression>
16151 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16152 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16153 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016154 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16155 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16156 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16157 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016158 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016159 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016160 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16161 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016162
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016163source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016164source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016165source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016166 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16167 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16168 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16169 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16170
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016171 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16172 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16173 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16174 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16175 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16176 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16177 server.
16178
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016179 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16180 specifying the source address without port(s).
16181
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016182ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016183 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16184 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16185 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16186 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16187 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16188 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016189 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16190 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016191
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016192ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16193 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16194 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16195 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16196
16197ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16198 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16199 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16200 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16201
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016202ssl-reuse
16203 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16204 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16205 default value.
16206 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16207 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16208
16209stick
16210 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16211 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16212 default value.
16213 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16214 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016215
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016216socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016217 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016218 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16219 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16220
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016221tcp-ut <delay>
16222 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016223 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016224 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016225 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016226 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16227 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16228 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16229 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16230 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16231 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16232 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16233 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16234 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16235
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016236tfo
16237 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16238 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16239 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16240 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016241 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016242 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016243
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016244track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016245 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16246 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16247 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
16248 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016249 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16250
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016251tls-tickets
16252 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16253 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16254 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016255 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16256 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16257 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016258 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016259 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016260
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016261verify [none|required]
16262 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016263 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016264 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16265 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016266 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016267 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16268 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16269 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16270 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16271 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16272 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16273 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16274 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016275
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016276verifyhost <hostname>
16277 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016278 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16279 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16280 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16281 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16282 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16283 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16284 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16285 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016287weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016288 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16289 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16290 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016291 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16292 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16293 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16294 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16295 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16296 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016297
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016298ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16299 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16300 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16301 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16302
16303 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16304 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16305 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16306 server ALPN contains it.
16307
16308 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16309 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16310 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16311 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16312
16313 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16314 favor of the ALPN extension.
16315
16316 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16317
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016318
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200163195.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16320-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016321
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016322HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16323using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016324configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016325This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16326can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16327workload.
16328This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16329resolution at run time.
16330Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16331carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16332
16333
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200163345.3.1. Global overview
16335----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016336
16337As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16338different steps of the process life:
16339
16340 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16341 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16342 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16343
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016344 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16345 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016346
16347A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16348 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16349 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16350 resolution to know this new IP.
16351
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016352When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016353HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016354SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16355from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016356will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016357will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016358
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016359A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016360 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016361 first valid response.
16362
16363 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16364 servers return an error.
16365
16366
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200163675.3.2. The resolvers section
16368----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016369
16370This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016371HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16372contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016373
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016374At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16375no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16376default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16377failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16378
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016379When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16380uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16381is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16382answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16383
16384When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016385used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016386
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016387 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16388 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16389 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016390
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016391 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16392 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016393
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016394 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016395 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16396 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016397
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016398For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16399following scenarios are possible:
16400
16401 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16402 ignored
16403
16404 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16405 applied
16406
16407 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
16408 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
16409
16410 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
16411 retries the query with a new type
16412
16413 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
16414 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016415
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016416As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016417a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016418<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016419
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016420
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016421resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016422 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016423
16424A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
16425
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016426accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016427 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016428 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016429 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
16430 by RFC 6891)
16431
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010016432 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
16433 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
16434 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
16435 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
16436 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
16437 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020016438
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016439nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
16440 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
16441 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
16442 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
16443 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
16444 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
16445 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
16446 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
16447 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
16448 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010016449 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
16450
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016451parse-resolv-conf
16452 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
16453 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
16454 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
16455
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016456hold <status> <period>
16457 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
16458 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016459 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016460 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016461 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
16462 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16463 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
16464
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020016465 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016466
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016467resolve_retries <nb>
16468 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
16469 giving up.
16470 Default value: 3
16471
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016472 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
16473 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
16474 type.
16475
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016476timeout <event> <time>
16477 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
16478 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
16479 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016480 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
16481 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016482 Default value: 1s
16483 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016484 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016485 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016486 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
16487 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
16488
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016489 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016490
16491 resolvers mydns
16492 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
16493 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016494 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016495 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016496 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016497 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016498 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010016499 hold other 30s
16500 hold refused 30s
16501 hold nx 30s
16502 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016503 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016504 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016505
16506
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200165076. Cache
16508---------
16509
16510HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
16511(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
16512RAM.
16513
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020016514The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
16515blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016516
16517If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
16518independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
16519when we try to allocate a new one.
16520
16521The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
16522
16523It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
16524"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
16525for more details.
16526
16527When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
16528replaced by "<CACHE>".
16529
16530
165316.1. Limitation
16532----------------
16533
16534The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
16535
16536- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010016537- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
16538 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
16539 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016540- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
16541- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010016542- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
16543 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
16544 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016545- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
16546 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010016547- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
16548 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
16549 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016550
16551- If the request is not a GET
16552- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
16553- If the request contains an Authorization header
16554
16555
165566.2. Setup
16557-----------
16558
16559To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
16560the corresponding http-request and response actions.
16561
16562
165636.2.1. Cache section
16564---------------------
16565
16566cache <name>
16567 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
16568 size of cache is mandatory.
16569
16570total-max-size <megabytes>
16571 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
16572 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
16573
16574max-object-size <bytes>
16575 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
16576 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
16577 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
16578
16579max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016580 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016581 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
16582 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
16583 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
16584 default.
16585
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016586process-vary <on/off>
16587 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016588 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
16589 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
16590 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010016591 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010016592
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010016593max-secondary-entries <number>
16594 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
16595 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
16596 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
16597
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020016598
165996.2.2. Proxy section
16600---------------------
16601
16602http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16603 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
16604 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
16605 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
16606 after this one.
16607
16608http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
16609 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
16610 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
16611 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
16612 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
16613
16614
16615Example:
16616
16617 backend bck1
16618 mode http
16619
16620 http-request cache-use foobar
16621 http-response cache-store foobar
16622 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
16623
16624 cache foobar
16625 total-max-size 4
16626 max-age 240
16627
16628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200166297. Using ACLs and fetching samples
16630----------------------------------
16631
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016632HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016633client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
16634The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
16635these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
16636but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
16637data called patterns.
16638
16639
166407.1. ACL basics
16641---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016642
16643The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
16644content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
16645from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
16646simple :
16647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016648 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016649 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016650 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
16651 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016653The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
16654adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016655
16656In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
16657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016658 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016659
16660This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
16661Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
16662and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016663an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
16664conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
16665as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
16666are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016667
16668ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
16669'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
16670which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
16671
16672There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
16673performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
16674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016675The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
16676specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
16677this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016678methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
16679ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016680
16681Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
16682 - boolean
16683 - integer (signed or unsigned)
16684 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
16685 - string
16686 - data block
16687
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016688Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
16689converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
16690would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
16691The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
16692which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
16693
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016694Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
16695keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
16696fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
16697which are summarized in the table below :
16698
16699 +---------------------+-----------------+
16700 | Sample or converter | Default |
16701 | output type | matching method |
16702 +---------------------+-----------------+
16703 | boolean | bool |
16704 +---------------------+-----------------+
16705 | integer | int |
16706 +---------------------+-----------------+
16707 | ip | ip |
16708 +---------------------+-----------------+
16709 | string | str |
16710 +---------------------+-----------------+
16711 | binary | none, use "-m" |
16712 +---------------------+-----------------+
16713
16714Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
16715matching method, see below.
16716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016717The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
16718 - boolean
16719 - integer or integer range
16720 - IP address / network
16721 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
16722 - regular expression
16723 - hex block
16724
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016725The following ACL flags are currently supported :
16726
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016727 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
16728 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016729 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016730 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016731 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016732 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016733 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
16734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016735The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
16736read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
16737if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
16738lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
16739will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
16740beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016741a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016742lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
16743exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
16744
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010016745The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
16746parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
16747ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
16748a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
16749check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
16750
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010016751The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
16752socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
16753file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
16754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016755Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
16756loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
16757
16758 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
16759
16760In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
16761the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
16762case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
16763as well.
16764
16765The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
16766sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
16767do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
16768methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
16769is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016770obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016771followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
16772default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
16773that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
16774string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
16775
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016776The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
16777By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
16778string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
16779resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016780server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016781waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010016782flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
16783function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
16784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016785There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
16786sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
16787be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016788
16789 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
16790 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016791 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
16792 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
16793 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
16794 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016795
16796 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
16797 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016799
16800 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016801 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016802
16803 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016804 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016805
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016806 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016807 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
16808
16809 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
16810 binary or string samples.
16811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016812 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
16813 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016815 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
16816 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
16817 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016819 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
16820 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016822 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
16823 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016825 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
16826 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016828 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
16829 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016830 This may be used with binary or string samples.
16831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016832 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
16833 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
16834 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016835
16836For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
16837request, it is possible to do :
16838
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016839 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016840
16841In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
16842buffer, one would use the following acl :
16843
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016844 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020016845
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016846On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
16847possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
16848
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016849 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016851All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
16852criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
16853method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010016854to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
16855usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
16856converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
16857method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
16858matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016859criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
16860the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016861
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016862If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016863the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
16864For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016866 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
16867 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
16868 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
16869 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016870
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020016871
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016872The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
16873types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
16874combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
16875brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
16876default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016878 +-------------------------------------------------+
16879 | Input sample type |
16880 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016881 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016882 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16883 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
16884 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016885 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016886 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016887 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016888 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016889 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016890 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016891 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016892 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020016893 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016894 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016895 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016896 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016897 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016898 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016899 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016900 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016901 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016902 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016903 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016904 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010016905 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016906 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
16907 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
16908 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016909
16910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169117.1.1. Matching booleans
16912------------------------
16913
16914In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
16915Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
16916When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
16917that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
16918
16919Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
16920return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
16921"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
16922
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169247.1.2. Matching integers
16925------------------------
16926
16927Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
16928enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
16929to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
16930
16931Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
16932matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
16933lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016934
16935For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
16936unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
16937representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
16938
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016939As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
16940two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
16941instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
16942ranges and operators.
16943
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016944For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016945operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
16946Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
16947of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016948
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016949Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016950
16951 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
16952 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
16953 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
16954 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
16955 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
16956
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016957For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016958
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016959 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016960
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016961This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16962
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010016963 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200169667.1.3. Matching strings
16967-----------------------
16968
16969String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16970different forms :
16971
16972 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016973 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016974
16975 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016976 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016977
16978 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16979 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16980
16981 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16982 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16983
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010016984 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
16985 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
16986 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
16987 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
16988 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
16989 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016990
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010016991 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
16992 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
16993 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
16994 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
16995 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
16996 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
16997 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
16998 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
16999 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17000 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17001 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017002
17003String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17004exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17005characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17006string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17007to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017008before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017009
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017010Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17011(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17012Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17013
17014Example:
17015 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17016 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17017
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170197.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17020---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017021
17022Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17023they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17024possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17025passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17026the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017027the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17028match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017029
17030
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200170317.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17032-------------------------------------
17033
17034It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17035not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17036a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17037to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17038digits may be used upper or lower case.
17039
17040Example :
17041 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017042 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017043
17044
170457.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17046---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017047
17048IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17049netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17050within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017051host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017052difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17053at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17054does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17055parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017056
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017057The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17058abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17059
17060 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17061 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17062 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17063 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17064 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17065 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17066 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17067 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17068
17069Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17070192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17071
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017072IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17073Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17074trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17075IPv6 patterns.
17076
17077HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17078following situations :
17079 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17080 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17081 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17082 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17083 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17084 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17085 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17086 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17087 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17088 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017090
170917.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17092----------------------------------
17093
17094Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17095combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17096
17097 - AND (implicit)
17098 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17099 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017101A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017103 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017105Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17106indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017108For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17109"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17110requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17111is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17112
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017113 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017114 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17115 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17116 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017117
17118To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17119and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17120
17121 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17122 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17123 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17124 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17125
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017126 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017127 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17128 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17129 use_backend www if host_www
17130
17131It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17132expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17133be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17134the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17135
17136 The following rule :
17137
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017138 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017139 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017140
17141 Can also be written that way :
17142
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017143 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017144
17145It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17146to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17147simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17148sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17149good use is the following :
17150
17151 With named ACLs :
17152
17153 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17154 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17155 monitor fail if site_dead
17156
17157 With anonymous ACLs :
17158
17159 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17160
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017161See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17162keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017163
17164
171657.3. Fetching samples
17166---------------------
17167
17168Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17169against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17170sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17171ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17172of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17173available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17174
17175This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17176Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17177compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17178deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17179
17180The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17181matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17182method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17183indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17184
17185As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17186when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17187mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17188the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17189ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17190
17191Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17192multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17193when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017194incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17195are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017196is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17197all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17198
17199Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17200 - name
17201 - name(arg1)
17202 - name(arg1,arg2)
17203
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017204
172057.3.1. Converters
17206-----------------
17207
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017208Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17209of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17210is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17211was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017212has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017213unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17214
17215These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17216sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17217the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017218support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017219
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017220A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17221support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17222supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17223(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17224bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017226The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017227
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001722851d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17229 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17230 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17231 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17232 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17233 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17234
17235 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017236 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17237 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017238 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17239 frontend http-in
17240 bind *:8081
17241 default_backend servers
17242 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17243 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17244
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017245rfc7239_is_valid
17246 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17247 otherwise.
17248
17249 Example:
17250 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17251 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17252 # output: TRUE
17253 #input: "proto=custom"
17254 # output: FALSE
17255
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017256rfc7239_field(<field>)
17257 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17258
17259 Supported fields are:
17260 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17261 - host: http compliant host
17262 - for: RFC7239 node
17263 - by: RFC7239 node
17264
17265 More info here:
17266 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17267
17268 Example:
17269 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17270 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17271 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17272 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17273
17274 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17275 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17276 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17277 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17278
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017279rfc7239_n2nn
17280 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17281 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17282 - ipv4 address
17283 - ipv6 address
17284 - 'unknown'
17285 - '_obfs' identifier
17286
17287 Example:
17288 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17289 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17290 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
17291 #input: "for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17292 # output: 127.0.0.1
17293 #input: "for=\"_name:_port\""
17294 # output: "_name"
17295
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017296rfc7239_n2np
17297 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17298 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17299 - unsigned integer
17300 - '_obfs' identifier
17301
17302 Example:
17303 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
17304 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
17305 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
17306 #input: "by=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17307 # output: 9999
17308 #input: "by=\"_name:_port\""
17309 # output: "_port"
17310
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017311add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017312 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017313 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017314 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17315 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017316 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017317 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17318 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17319 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17320 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017321 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017322 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017323
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017324add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
17325 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
17326 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
17327 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17328 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17329 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17330 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17331 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17332 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17333 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17334 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17335 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17336 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17337 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17338 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17339 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17340 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17341 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017342 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17343 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017344
17345 Example:
17346 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17347 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17348 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17349 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17350
17351 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17352 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17353
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017354aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17355 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17356 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17357 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17358 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17359 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17360 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17361
17362 Example:
17363 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17364 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
17365
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017366and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017367 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017368 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017369 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17370 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017371 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017372 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17373 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17374 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17375 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017376 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017377 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017378
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017379b64dec
17380 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
17381 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017382 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
17383 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017384
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017385base64
17386 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017387 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017388 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
17389 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017390
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020017391be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
17392 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
17393 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
17394 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
17395 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
17396 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
17397
17398 Example:
17399 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
17400 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
17401 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
17402 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
17403
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020017404be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
17405 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
17406 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
17407 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
17408 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
17409 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
17410 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
17411
17412 Example:
17413 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
17414 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
17415 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
17416 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
17417
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017418bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017419 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017420 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017421 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017422 presence of a flag).
17423
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017424bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
17425 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
17426 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017427 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010017428
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017429concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
17430 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
17431 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
17432 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
17433 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17434 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
17435 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
17436 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
17437 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
17438 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
17439 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017440 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040017441 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017442 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017443 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
17444 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
17445 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017446
17447 Example:
17448 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
17449 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
17450 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017451 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020017452 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010017453 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
17454
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017455cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017456 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
17457 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017458
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017459crc32([<avalanche>])
17460 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
17461 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17462 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17463 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17464 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17465 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
17466 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
17467 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
17468 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
17469 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017470 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
17471
17472crc32c([<avalanche>])
17473 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
17474 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17475 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17476 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
17477 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
17478 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
17479 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
17480 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010017481
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020017482cut_crlf
17483 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
17484 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
17485 updated.
17486
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010017487da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017488 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
17489 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
17490 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
17491 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017492 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017493 configuration language.
17494
17495 Example:
17496 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017497 bind *:8881
17498 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000017499 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020017500
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010017501debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
17502 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
17503 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
17504 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
17505 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
17506 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
17507 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
17508 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
17509 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
17510 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
17511 printable sample types.
17512
17513 Example:
17514 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020017515
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017516digest(<algorithm>)
17517 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
17518 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
17519
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017520 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017521 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17522
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017523div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017524 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17525 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017526 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017527 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
17528 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017529 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017530 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17531 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17532 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17533 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017534 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017535 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017536
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017537djb2([<avalanche>])
17538 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
17539 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17540 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17541 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17542 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17543 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17544 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017545 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
17546 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017547
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017548even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017549 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017550 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
17551
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017552field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17553 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
17554 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
17555 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
17556 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
17557 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
17558 fields.
17559
17560 Example :
17561 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
17562 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17563 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
17564 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
17565 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010017566
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017567fix_is_valid
17568 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
17569 Information eXchange):
17570
17571 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
17572 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050017573 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017574 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010017575 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017576 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
17577 checksum
17578
17579 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17580 the server can be parsed.
17581
17582 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
17583 message, false if not.
17584
17585 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
17586
17587 Example:
17588 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17589 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17590
17591fix_tag_value(<tag>)
17592 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
17593 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
17594 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
17595 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050017596 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020017597 added.
17598
17599 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
17600 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
17601 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
17602 fix_is_valid converter.
17603
17604 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
17605
17606 Example:
17607 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17608 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
17609 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
17610 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
17611 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
17612
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017613hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017614 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017615 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017616 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017617 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010017618
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017619hex2i
17620 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017621 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020017622
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020017623htonl
17624 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
17625 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
17626 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
17627 unsigned 32-bit integer.
17628
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017629hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017630 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
17631 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
17632 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
17633 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
17634
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017635 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020017636 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17637
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020017638host_only
17639 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
17640 The input must respect the format of the host header value
17641 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
17642 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
17643
17644 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
17645
17646 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
17647
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017648http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017649 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17650 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017651 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
17652 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
17653 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
17654 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
17655 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
17656 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
17657 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
17658 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017659
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017660iif(<true>,<false>)
17661 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
17662 string otherwise.
17663
17664 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020017665 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020017666
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017667in_table(<table>)
17668 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17669 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
17670 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017671 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017672 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
17673
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010017674ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017675 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017676 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010017677 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
17678 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
17679 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
17680 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
17681 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017682
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017683json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017684 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017685 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017686 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017687 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
17688 of errors:
17689 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
17690 bytes, ...)
17691 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
17692 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
17693
17694 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
17695 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
17696 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
17697 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
17698 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
17699 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017700 - "ascii" : never fails;
17701 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
17702 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017703 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017704 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017705 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
17706 characters corresponding to the other errors.
17707
17708 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017709 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017710
17711 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017712 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020017713 capture request header user-agent len 150
17714 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020017715
17716 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
17717 GET / HTTP/1.0
17718 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
17719
17720 Output log:
17721 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
17722
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020017723json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
17724 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
17725 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
17726 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
17727 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
17728
17729 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
17730 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
17731
17732 Example:
17733 # get a integer value from the request body
17734 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
17735 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
17736
17737 # get a key with '.' in the name
17738 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
17739 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
17740
17741 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
17742 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
17743
17744 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
17745 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
17746
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020017747jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17748 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
17749 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
17750 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
17751 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17752 json_path and output_type parameters.
17753
17754 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17755 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17756
17757jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
17758 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
17759 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
17760 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
17761 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
17762 json_path and output_type parameters.
17763
17764 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17765 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17766
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017767jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
17768 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
17769 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017770 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017771 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
17772 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
17773 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
17774 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017775
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017776 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
17777 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
17778 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
17779 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017780
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017781 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
17782 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
17783 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
17784 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
17785 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
17786 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017787 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017788 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
17789
17790 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
17791 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
17792 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
17793 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
17794 contents.
17795
17796 The possible return values are the following :
17797
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017798 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
17799 | ID | message |
17800 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017801 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050017802 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020017803 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
17804 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
17805 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
17806 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
17807 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020017808 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020017809
17810 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
17811 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17812
17813 Example:
17814 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
17815 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
17816 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
17817 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
17818 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
17819 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
17820
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017821language(<value>[,<default>])
17822 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
17823 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
17824 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
17825 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
17826 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
17827 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
17828 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
17829 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
17830 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017831 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017832 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
17833 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017834
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017835 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017836
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017837 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
17838 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017839
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017840 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
17841 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
17842 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
17843 use_backend spanish if es
17844 use_backend french if fr
17845 use_backend english if en
17846 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020017847
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010017848length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010017849 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
17850 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17851 type. The result is of type integer.
17852
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017853lower
17854 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
17855 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17856 type. The result is of type string.
17857
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017858ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
17859 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17860 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
17861 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17862 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17863 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17864 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
17865
17866 Example :
17867
17868 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017869 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017870 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17871
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020017872ltrim(<chars>)
17873 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
17874 representation of the input sample.
17875
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017876map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17877map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17878map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
17879 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
17880 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
17881 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
17882 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
17883 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
17884 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
17885 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
17886 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017887
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017888 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
17889 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
17890 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017891
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017892 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017893 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017894
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017895 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
17896 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17897 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
17898 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020017899 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
17900 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017901 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
17902 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17903 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
17904 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17905 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
17906 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17907 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
17908 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080017909 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
17910 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17911 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017912 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17913 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
17914 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
17915 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
17916 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017917
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010017918 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
17919 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
17920 the corresponding match text.
17921
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017922 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
17923 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
17924 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
17925 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
17926 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017927
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017928 Example :
17929
17930 # this is a comment and is ignored
17931 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
17932 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
17933 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
17934 | | | `---------- value
17935 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
17936 | `---------------------------- key
17937 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
17938
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017939mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017940 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
17941 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017942 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017943 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017944 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017945 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17946 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17947 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17948 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017949 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017950 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017951
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017952mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010017953 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
17954 <packettype>.
17955 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
17956 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
17957 from.
17958 Supported string and integers can be found here:
17959 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
17960 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
17961
17962 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
17963 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
17964 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
17965 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
17966
17967 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
17968 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
17969 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17970 packets only):
17971 17: Session Expiry Interval
17972 33: Receive Maximum
17973 39: Maximum Packet Size
17974 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17975 25: Request Response Information
17976 23: Request Problem Information
17977 21: Authentication Method
17978 22: Authentication Data
17979 18: Will Delay Interval
17980 1: Payload Format Indicator
17981 2: Message Expiry Interval
17982 3: Content Type
17983 8: Response Topic
17984 9: Correlation Data
17985 Not supported yet:
17986 38: User Property
17987
17988 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
17989 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
17990 packets only):
17991 17: Session Expiry Interval
17992 33: Receive Maximum
17993 36: Maximum QoS
17994 37: Retain Available
17995 39: Maximum Packet Size
17996 18: Assigned Client Identifier
17997 34: Topic Alias Maximum
17998 31: Reason String
17999 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18000 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18001 42: Shared Subscription Available
18002 19: Server Keep Alive
18003 26: Response Information
18004 28: Server Reference
18005 21: Authentication Method
18006 22: Authentication Data
18007 Not supported yet:
18008 38: User Property
18009
18010 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18011 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18012 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18013 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18014
18015 Example:
18016
18017 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18018 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18019 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18020 if data_in_buffer
18021 # do the same as above
18022 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18023 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18024 if data_in_buffer
18025
18026mqtt_is_valid
18027 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18028
18029 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18030 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18031 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18032 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18033
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018034 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18035
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018036 Example:
18037
18038 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018039 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018040
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018041mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018042 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018043 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18044 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018045 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018046 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018047 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018048 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18049 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18050 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18051 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018052 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018053 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018054
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018055nbsrv
18056 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18057 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18058 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18059 map lookup.
18060
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018061neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018062 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18063 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18064 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18065 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018066
18067not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018068 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018069 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018070 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018071 absence of a flag).
18072
18073odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018074 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018075 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18076
18077or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018078 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018079 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018080 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18081 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018082 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018083 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18084 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18085 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18086 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018087 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018088 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018089
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018090param(<name>,[<delim>])
18091 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18092 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18093 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18094 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18095 a value of an empty string.
18096
18097 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18098 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18099 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18100 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18101
18102 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18103 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18104 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18105 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18106 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18107 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18108
18109 Example :
18110 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18111 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18112 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18113 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18114 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18115
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018116port_only
18117 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18118 returning its port.
18119 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18120 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18121 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18122
18123 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18124
18125 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18126
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018127protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18128 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18129 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18130 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18131 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18132 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18133 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18134 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18135 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18136 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18137 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18138 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18139
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018140regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018141 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18142 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18143 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18144 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18145 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18146 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18147 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18148 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18149 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018150 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18151 of characters with other ones.
18152
18153 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18154 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18155 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18156 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18157 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18158 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018159
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018160 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018161
18162 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18163 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18164 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018165 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018166
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018167 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18168 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18169
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018170 # capture groups and backreferences
18171 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018172 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018173 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18174
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018175capture-req(<id>)
18176 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18177 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18178
18179 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018180 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18181 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018182
18183capture-res(<id>)
18184 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18185 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18186
18187 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018188 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18189 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018190
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018191rtrim(<chars>)
18192 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18193 of the input sample.
18194
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018195sdbm([<avalanche>])
18196 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18197 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18198 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18199 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18200 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18201 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18202 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018203 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18204 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018205
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018206secure_memcmp(<var>)
18207 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18208 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18209 match.
18210
18211 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18212 performed in constant time.
18213
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018214 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018215 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18216
18217 Example :
18218
18219 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18220 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18221 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18222 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18223
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018224set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018225 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018226 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18227 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18228 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18229 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018230 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018231 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18232 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018233 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018234 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18235 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018236 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018237 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018238
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018239 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18240 possible conditions :
18241 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18242 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18243 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18244 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18245 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18246 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18247 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18248 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18249 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18250 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18251 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18252 called on the variable.
18253 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18254 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18255 configuration parsing.
18256 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18257 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18258 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18259 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18260 true by default.
18261
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018262sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018263 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018264 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18265
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018266sha2([<bits>])
18267 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18268 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18269
18270 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18271 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18272
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018273 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018274 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18275
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018276srv_queue
18277 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18278 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18279 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18280 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18281 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18282
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018283strcmp(<var>)
18284 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18285 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18286 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18287 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18288 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18289 shorter).
18290
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018291 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18292 strings in constant time.
18293
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018294 Example :
18295
18296 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18297 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18298 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18299
18300
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018301sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018302 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
18303 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018304 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018305 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
18306 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018307 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018308 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18309 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018310 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018311 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18312 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018313 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018314 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018315
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018316table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
18317 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18318 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18319 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
18320 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18321 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18322 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
18323
18324
18325table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
18326 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18327 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18328 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18329 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18330 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18331 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18332
18333table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18334 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18335 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018336 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018337 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18338 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18339
18340table_conn_cur(<table>)
18341 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18342 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18343 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18344 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18345 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18346
18347table_conn_rate(<table>)
18348 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18349 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18350 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18351 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18352 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18353
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018354table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18355 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18356 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18357 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18358 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18359 input sample in the designated table.
18360 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18361
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018362table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18363 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18364 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18365 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
18366 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
18367 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18368 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18369 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
18370 data-type).
18371 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18372
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018373table_gpt0(<table>)
18374 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18375 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18376 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18377 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18378 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
18379
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018380table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
18381 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18382 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18383 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
18384 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
18385 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
18386 between 0 and 99.
18387 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18388 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18389 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18390 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
18391
18392table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
18393 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18394 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18395 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
18396 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
18397 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
18398 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18399 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
18400 value 0.
18401 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
18402 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18403 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
18404
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018405table_gpc0(<table>)
18406 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18407 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18408 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18409 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18410 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
18411
18412table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
18413 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18414 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18415 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
18416 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18417 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
18418 sample fetch keyword.
18419
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018420table_gpc1(<table>)
18421 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18422 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18423 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
18424 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
18425 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
18426
18427table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
18428 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18429 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18430 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
18431 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
18432 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
18433 sample fetch keyword.
18434
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018435table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
18436 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18437 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018438 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018439 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18440 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18441
18442table_http_err_rate(<table>)
18443 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18444 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18445 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
18446 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
18447 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
18448 keyword.
18449
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018450table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
18451 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18452 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18453 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
18454 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18455 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18456
18457table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
18458 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18459 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18460 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
18461 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
18462 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
18463 keyword.
18464
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018465table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
18466 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18467 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018468 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018469 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
18470 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18471
18472table_http_req_rate(<table>)
18473 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18474 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18475 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
18476 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
18477 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
18478 keyword.
18479
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010018480table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018481 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18482 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18483 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18484 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
18485 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
18486 updated.
18487 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
18488
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018489table_kbytes_in(<table>)
18490 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18491 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018492 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018493 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18494 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18495 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
18496 keyword.
18497
18498table_kbytes_out(<table>)
18499 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18500 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018501 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018502 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
18503 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
18504 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
18505 keyword.
18506
18507table_server_id(<table>)
18508 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18509 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18510 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
18511 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
18512 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
18513 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
18514
18515table_sess_cnt(<table>)
18516 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18517 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018518 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018519 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
18520 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18521 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
18522 keyword.
18523
18524table_sess_rate(<table>)
18525 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18526 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18527 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
18528 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
18529 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
18530 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
18531 keyword.
18532
18533table_trackers(<table>)
18534 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18535 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18536 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18537 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
18538 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
18539 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
18540 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
18541 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
18542 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
18543 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
18544
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020018545ub64dec
18546 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
18547 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
18548 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
18549
18550 Example:
18551 # Decoding a JWT payload:
18552 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
18553
18554ub64enc
18555 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
18556
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018557upper
18558 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
18559 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18560 type. The result is of type string.
18561
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020018562url_dec([<in_form>])
18563 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
18564 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
18565 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
18566 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
18567 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
18568 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020018569
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010018570url_enc([<enc_type>])
18571 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
18572 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
18573 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
18574 optional argument is here for future changes.
18575
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018576ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018577 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018578 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
18579 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
18580 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018581 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18582 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18583 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18584 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018585 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018586 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18587 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018588
18589 Example:
18590 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
18591 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
18592
18593 message Point {
18594 int32 latitude = 1;
18595 int32 longitude = 2;
18596 }
18597
18598 message PPoint {
18599 Point point = 59;
18600 }
18601
18602 message Rectangle {
18603 // One corner of the rectangle.
18604 PPoint lo = 48;
18605 // The other corner of the rectangle.
18606 PPoint hi = 49;
18607 }
18608
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018609 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
18610 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
18611 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018612
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018613 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18614 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018615 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018616 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
18617
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018618 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018619
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010018620 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010018621
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018622 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
18623 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
18624 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018625
18626 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
18627 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
18628 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
18629
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020018630 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
18631 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
18632 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018633
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010018634
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010018635unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010018636 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
18637 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
18638 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
18639 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18640 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
18641 response),
18642 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18643 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
18644 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
18645 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
18646
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018647utime(<format>[,<offset>])
18648 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18649 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
18650 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18651 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18652 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18653 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
18654
18655 Example :
18656
18657 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018658 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018659 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18660
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018661word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18662 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
18663 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
18664 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018665 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018666 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
18667 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
18668
18669 Example :
18670 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
18671 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18672 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
18673 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
18674 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010018675 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010018676
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018677wt6([<avalanche>])
18678 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
18679 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18680 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18681 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18682 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18683 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18684 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018685 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
18686 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018687
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018688xor(<value>)
18689 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018690 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018691 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018692 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018693 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018694 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18695 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018696 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018697 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18698 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018699 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018700 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018701
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010018702xxh3([<seed>])
18703 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
18704 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
18705 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
18706 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
18707 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
18708 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
18709 considered as cryptographically secure.
18710
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010018711xxh32([<seed>])
18712 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
18713 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18714 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18715 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18716 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18717 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18718 as cryptographically secure.
18719
18720xxh64([<seed>])
18721 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
18722 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
18723 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
18724 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
18725 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
18726 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
18727 as cryptographically secure.
18728
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010018729x509_v_err_str
18730 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
18731 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
18732 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
18733
18734 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
18735 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
18736 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
18737
18738 Example:
18739
18740 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18741
18742 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
18743 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
18744 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
18745
18746 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
18747 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
18748 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018749
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187507.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018751--------------------------------------------
18752
18753A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
18754not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
18755"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
18756The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
18757
18758always_false : boolean
18759 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18760 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18761
18762always_true : boolean
18763 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
18764 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
18765
18766avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018767 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018768 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
18769 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
18770 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
18771 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
18772 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
18773 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
18774 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
18775 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
18776 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
18777 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
18778 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
18779 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
18780 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010018781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018782be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018783 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
18784 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
18785 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
18786 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018787 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
18788
18789be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
18790 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
18791 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
18792 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
18793 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
18794 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040018795 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
18796 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040018797
18798 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
18799 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
18800 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020018801
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018802be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
18803 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18804 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18805 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018806 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018807 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
18808 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018809
18810 Example :
18811 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
18812 backend dynamic
18813 mode http
18814 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
18815 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018816
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018817bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018818 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
18819 of the string.
18820
18821bool(<bool>) : bool
18822 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
18823 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
18824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018825connslots([<backend>]) : integer
18826 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018827 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018828 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
18829 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050018830
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018831 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018832 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018833 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
18834
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018835 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
18836 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018837
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018838 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018839 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018840 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018841 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018842 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018844 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018845
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018846 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
18847 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018848 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020018849 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080018850
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010018851cpu_calls : integer
18852 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
18853 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
18854 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
18855 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
18856 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
18857 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
18858
18859cpu_ns_avg : integer
18860 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18861 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18862 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18863 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18864 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18865 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18866 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
18867 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
18868 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
18869 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
18870 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
18871
18872cpu_ns_tot : integer
18873 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
18874 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
18875 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
18876 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
18877 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
18878 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
18879 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
18880 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
18881 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
18882 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
18883 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
18884 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
18885 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
18886
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018887date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018888 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018889
18890 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
18891 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
18892 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018893 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
18894
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018895 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
18896 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
18897 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
18898 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
18899 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
18900
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020018901 Example :
18902
18903 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
18904 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020018905
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018906 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
18907 # millisecond granularity
18908 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
18909
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010018910date_us : integer
18911 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
18912 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
18913 from the same timeval structure.
18914
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018915env(<name>) : string
18916 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
18917 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
18918 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
18919 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
18920 certain way.
18921
18922 Examples :
18923 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
18924 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
18925
18926 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018927 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020018928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018929fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
18930 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018931 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
18932 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018933 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
18934 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018935 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018936 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
18937 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020018938
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020018939fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18940 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
18941 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
18942 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
18943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018944fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
18945 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
18946 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
18947 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
18948 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
18949 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
18950 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
18951 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
18952 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018953
18954 Example :
18955 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
18956 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
18957 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
18958 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
18959 frontend mail
18960 bind :25
18961 mode tcp
18962 maxconn 100
18963 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
18964 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
18965 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
18966 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018967
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010018968hostname : string
18969 Returns the system hostname.
18970
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018971int(<integer>) : signed integer
18972 Returns a signed integer.
18973
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018974ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
18975 Returns an ipv4.
18976
18977ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
18978 Returns an ipv6.
18979
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018980last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018981 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
18982 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
18983 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18984 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18985 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
18986 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
18987 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
18988 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
18989 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
18990 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
18991 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
18992 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
18993
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020018994last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010018995 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
18996 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
18997 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
18998 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
18999 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19000 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19001 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19002 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19003 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19004 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19005 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19006 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19007
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019008lat_ns_avg : integer
19009 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19010 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19011 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19012 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19013 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19014 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19015 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19016 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19017 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019018 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19019 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19020 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19021 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19022 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19023 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019024
19025lat_ns_tot : integer
19026 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19027 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19028 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19029 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19030 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19031 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19032 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19033 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19034 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019035 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19036 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19037 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19038 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19039 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019040 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19041 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19042 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19043 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19044 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19045 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19046
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019047meth(<method>) : method
19048 Returns a method.
19049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019050nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19051 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19052 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19053 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019054 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19055 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19056 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019057
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019058prio_class : integer
19059 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19060 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19061 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19062
19063prio_offset : integer
19064 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19065 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19066 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19067 set-priority-offset".
19068
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019069proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019070 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19071 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019073queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019074 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19075 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19076 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019077 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19078 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19079 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19080 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19081 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19082
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019083quic_enabled : boolean
19084 Warning: QUIC support in HAProxy is currently experimental. Configuration may
19085 change without deprecation in the future.
19086
19087 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19088 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19089 global option.
19090
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019091rand([<range>]) : integer
19092 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19093 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19094 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19095 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19096 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019098srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19099 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19100 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19101 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19102 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19103 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019104 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19105 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19106
19107srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19108 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19109 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19110 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19111 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19112 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19113 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19114 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19115
19116 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19117 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019118
19119srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19120 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19121 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19122 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019123 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019124 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19125 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19126 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19127
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019128srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19129 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19130 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19131 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19132 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19133 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19134 fetch methods.
19135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019136srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19137 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19138 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019139 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019140 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19141 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019142 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143 overloading servers).
19144
19145 Example :
19146 # Redirect to a separate back
19147 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19148 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19149 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19150
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019151srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019152 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19153 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19154 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19155
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019156srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019157 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19158 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19159 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19160
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019161srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019162 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19163 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19164 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19165
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019166stopping : boolean
19167 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19168 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19169 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19170
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019171str(<string>) : string
19172 Returns a string.
19173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019174table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19175 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19176 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19177
19178table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19179 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19180 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19181 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19182
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019183thread : integer
19184 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19185 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19186 and debugging purposes.
19187
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019188uuid([<version>]) : string
19189 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19190 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19191 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19192
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019193var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019194 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019195 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19196 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19197 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019198 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019199 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19200 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019201 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019202 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19203 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019204 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019205 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019206
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192077.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019208----------------------------------
19209
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019210The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019211closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19212methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19213sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19214TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019215the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19216counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019217"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019218used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19219counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19220"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19221An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19222currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19223the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019224
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019225bc_dst : ip
19226 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19227 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19228 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19229 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19230
19231bc_dst_port : integer
19232 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019233 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019234
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019235bc_err : integer
19236 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19237 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19238 and their corresponding error message.
19239
19240bc_err_str : string
19241 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19242 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19243 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19244 corresponding error message.
19245
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019246bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019247 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19248 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19249 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19250
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019251bc_src : ip
19252 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019253 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019254 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19255 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19256
19257bc_src_port : integer
19258 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019259 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019261be_id : integer
19262 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019263 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19264 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019265
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019266be_name : string
19267 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019268 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19269 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019270
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010019271be_server_timeout : integer
19272 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
19273 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19274 also the "cur_server_timeout".
19275
19276be_tunnel_timeout : integer
19277 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
19278 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19279 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
19280
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010019281cur_server_timeout : integer
19282 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19283 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
19284 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
19285
19286cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
19287 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19288 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
19289 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
19290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019291dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019292 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
19293 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
19294 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
19295 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
19296 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
19297 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
19298 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
19299 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
19300 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
19301 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
19302 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019303
19304dst_conn : integer
19305 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19306 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
19307 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
19308 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
19309 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
19310 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
19311 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
19312 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019313
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019314dst_is_local : boolean
19315 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
19316 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
19317 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
19318 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019319 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019320 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
19321 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
19322 it only once per connection.
19323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019324dst_port : integer
19325 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
19326 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019327 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
19328 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
19329 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
19330 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019331
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019332fc_dst : ip
19333 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19334 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
19335 for details.
19336
19337fc_dst_is_local : boolean
19338 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
19339 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
19340 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
19341
19342fc_dst_port : integer
19343 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
19344 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
19345 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
19346
19347fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019348 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
19349 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
19350 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019351 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019352 error codes and their corresponding error message.
19353
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019354fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050019355 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019356 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019357 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019358 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
19359
19360 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19361 | ID | message |
19362 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19363 | 0 | "Success" |
19364 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
19365 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
19366 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
19367 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
19368 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
19369 | 6 | "General socket error" |
19370 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
19371 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
19372 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
19373 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
19374 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19375 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19376 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19377 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
19378 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
19379 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
19380 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
19381 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19382 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19383 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
19384 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
19385 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
19386 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
19387 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
19388 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
19389 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
19390 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
19391 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
19392 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
19393 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
19394 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
19395 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
19396 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
19397 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
19398 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
19399 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
19400 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
19401 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
19402 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
19403 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
19404 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
19405 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020019406 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019407 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19408
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019409fc_fackets : integer
19410 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
19411 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19412 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19413 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19414
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020019415fc_http_major : integer
19416 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19417 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19418 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
19419
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019420fc_lost : integer
19421 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
19422 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19423 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19424 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19425
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020019426fc_pp_authority : string
19427 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19428 if any.
19429
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010019430fc_pp_unique_id : string
19431 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
19432 if any.
19433
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010019434fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
19435 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
19436 header.
19437
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019438fc_reordering : integer
19439 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
19440 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19441 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19442 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19443
19444fc_retrans : integer
19445 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
19446 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
19447 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
19448 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19449
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020019450fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19451 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
19452 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19453 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19454 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19455 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19456 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19457
19458fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19459 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19460 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19461 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19462 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19463 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19464 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19465
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020019466fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019467 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19468 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19469 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19470 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19471
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019472fc_src : ip
19473 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19474 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
19475 for details.
19476
19477fc_src_is_local : boolean
19478 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
19479 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
19480 "src_is_local" for details.
19481
19482fc_src_port : integer
19483
19484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
19485 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
19486 this address. See "src-port" for details.
19487
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019488
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020019489fc_unacked : integer
19490 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
19491 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
19492 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
19493 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070019494
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020019495fe_defbe : string
19496 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
19497 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
19498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019499fe_id : integer
19500 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010019501 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019502 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19503
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019504fe_name : string
19505 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
19506 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
19507 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
19508
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010019509fe_client_timeout : integer
19510 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
19511 current frontend.
19512
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019513sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019514sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19515sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19516sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019517 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
19518 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19519 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
19520
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019521sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019522sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19523sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19524sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019525 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
19526 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
19527 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
19528
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019529sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19530 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19531 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19532 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19533 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19534 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19535 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19536 will always return zero.
19537 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19538 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19539
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019540sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019541sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19542sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19543sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019544 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19545 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019546 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19547 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19548 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019549
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019550 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019551 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19552 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019553 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19554 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
19555 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019556 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19557 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19558
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019559sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19560sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19561sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19562sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19563 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
19564 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
19565 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
19566 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
19567 when a first ACL was verified.
19568
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019569sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019570sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19571sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19572sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019573 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019574 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
19575
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019576sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019577sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19578sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
19579sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019580 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19581 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
19582 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
19583
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019584sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019585sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19586sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19587sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019588 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
19589 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
19590 See also src_conn_rate.
19591
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019592sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19593 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
19594 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
19595 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
19596 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19597 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
19598 index, zero is returned.
19599 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19600 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
19601
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019602sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019603sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19604sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19605sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019606 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019607 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019608
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019609sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19610sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19611sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19612sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19613 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19614 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
19615
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019616sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19617 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19618 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
19619 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19620 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19621 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
19622 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
19623 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
19624
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019625sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19626sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19627sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19628sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19629 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19630 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
19631
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019632sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19633 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19634 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
19635 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
19636 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
19637 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
19638 between 0 and 2.
19639 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
19640 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19641 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19642 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19643 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19644
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019645sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019646sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19647sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
19648sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019649 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
19650 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19651 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019652 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19653 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19654 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019655
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019656sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19657sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19658sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19659sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19660 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19661 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
19662 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19663 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19664 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19665 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19666
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019667sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019668sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19669sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19670sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019671 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019672 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
19673 See also src_http_err_cnt.
19674
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019675sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019676sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19677sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19678sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019679 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
19680 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19681 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
19682 src_http_err_rate.
19683
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019684sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19685sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19686sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19687sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19688 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
19689 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
19690 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
19691
19692sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19693sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19694sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19695sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19696 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
19697 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
19698 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
19699 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
19700
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019701sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019702sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19703sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19704sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019705 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019706 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19707 src_http_req_cnt.
19708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019709sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019710sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19711sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
19712sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019713 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
19714 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
19715 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
19716 src_http_req_rate.
19717
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019718sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19719 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19720 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
19721 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
19722 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
19723 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
19724 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
19725 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
19726 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19727 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19728
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019729sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019730sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19731sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19732sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019733 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019734 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19735 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19736 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19737 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019738
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019739 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019740 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
19741 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019742 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19743
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019744sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
19745sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19746sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19747sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19748 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
19749 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
19750 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
19751 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
19752 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
19753
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019754sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019755sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19756sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
19757sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019758 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
19759 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19760 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019761
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019762sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019763sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19764sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
19765sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020019766 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
19767 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
19768 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019769
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019770sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019771sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19772sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19773sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019774 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019775 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
19776 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
19777 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019778 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019779 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
19780
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019781sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019782sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19783sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
19784sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019785 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
19786 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
19787 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
19788 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
19789 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019790 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020019791
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019792sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019793sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19794sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
19795sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020019796 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
19797 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
19798 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
19799
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020019800sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020019801sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19802sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
19803sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019804 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
19805 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019806 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019807 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
19808 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019809 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
19810 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
19811 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010019812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019813so_id : integer
19814 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
19815 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
19816 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019817
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010019818so_name : string
19819 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
19820 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
19821 strings instead of integers.
19822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019823src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019824 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
19825 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
19826 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19827 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
19828 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
19829 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
19830 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
19831 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
19832 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
19833 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
19834 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
19835 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
19836 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
19837 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
19838 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019839
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019840 Example:
19841 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
19842 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
19843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019844src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
19845 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
19846 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
19847 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019848 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019850src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
19851 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
19852 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019853 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019854 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019855
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019856src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19857 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
19858 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19859 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
19860 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19861 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
19862 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
19863 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19864 See also sc_clr_gpc.
19865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019866src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
19867 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19868 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19869 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19870 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19871 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19872 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019873
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019874 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019875 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
19876 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
19877 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
19878 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010019879 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020019880 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
19881 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
19882
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019883src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19884 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
19885 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
19886 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
19887 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
19888 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
19889 was verified.
19890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019891src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019892 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019893 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019894 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019895 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019897src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019898 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019899 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19900 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019901 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019903src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
19904 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
19905 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19906 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019907 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019908
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019909src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
19910 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
19911 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19912 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
19913 is an integer between 0 and 99.
19914 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
19915 is returned.
19916 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
19917 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
19918 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
19919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019920src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019921 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019922 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019923 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019924 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019925
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019926src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
19927 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
19928 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19929 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19930 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
19931
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020019932src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19933 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
19934 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
19935 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
19936 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19937 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
19938 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
19939
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020019940src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
19941 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
19942 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
19943 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19944 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
19945
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020019946src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
19947 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
19948 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
19949 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
19950 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
19951 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
19952 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
19953 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
19954 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
19955 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
19956 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
19957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019958src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019959 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019960 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019961 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19962 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019963 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
19964 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19965 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020019966
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019967src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
19968 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
19969 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
19970 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
19971 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
19972 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
19973 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
19974 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
19975
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019976src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019977 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019978 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019979 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019980 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019981 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019982
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019983src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
19984 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
19985 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
19986 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
19987 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019988 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020019989
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019990src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19991 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
19992 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050019993 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019994 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
19995 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
19996
19997src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
19998 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
19999 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20000 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20001 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20002 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20003 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020005src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020006 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020007 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20008 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020009 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020011src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20012 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20013 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20014 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020015 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020016 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020017
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020018src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20019 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20020 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20021 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20022 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20023 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20024 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20025 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20026 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020028src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20029 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20030 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20031 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020032 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020033 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20034 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020035
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020036 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020037 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020038 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020039 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020040
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020041src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20042 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20043 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20044 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20045 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20046 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20047 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20048
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020049src_is_local : boolean
20050 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20051 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20052 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20053 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020054 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020055 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20056 once per connection.
20057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020058src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020059 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20060 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20061 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20062 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20063 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020065src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020066 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20067 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20068 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20069 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20070 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020072src_port : integer
20073 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020074 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20075 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20076 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20077 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020079src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020080 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020081 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20082 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20083 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020084 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020086src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20087 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20088 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20089 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20090 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020091 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020093src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20094 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20095 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20096 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20097 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20098 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20099 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20100 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20101 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020102
20103 Example :
20104 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20105 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20106 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20107 listen ssh
20108 bind :22
20109 mode tcp
20110 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020111 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020112 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020113 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20114
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020115srv_id : integer
20116 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20117 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020118 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020119
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020120srv_name : string
20121 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20122 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020123 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020124
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200201257.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020126----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020127
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020128The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020129closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20130when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20131usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020132future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020133
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002013451d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20135 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20136 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20137 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20138 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20139 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20140
20141 Example :
20142 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20143 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20144 # the request.
20145 frontend http-in
20146 bind *:8081
20147 default_backend servers
20148 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20149 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20150
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020151ssl_bc : boolean
20152 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20153 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020154 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20155 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020156
20157ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20158 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020159 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20160 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020161
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020162ssl_bc_alpn : string
20163 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20164 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020165 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020166 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20167 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20168 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20169 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20170 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020171 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20172 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020173
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020174ssl_bc_cipher : string
20175 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020176 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20177 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020178
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020179ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20180 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20181 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20182 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020183 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020184
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020185ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020186 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020187 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20188 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20189 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20190 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020191 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20192 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20193 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20194
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020195ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020196 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020197 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20198 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20199 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020200
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020201ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20202 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20203 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020204 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20205 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020206
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020207ssl_bc_npn : string
20208 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20209 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020210 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020211 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20212 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20213 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20214 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020215 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20216 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020217
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020218ssl_bc_protocol : string
20219 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020220 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20221 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020222
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020223ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020224 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020225 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020226 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20227 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020228
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020229ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20230 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20231 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20232 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020233 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020234
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020235ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20236 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20237 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020238 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20239 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020240
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020241ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20242 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20243 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20244 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020245 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020246
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020247ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
20248 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020249 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20250 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020252ssl_c_ca_err : integer
20253 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20254 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
20255 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
20256 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
20257 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020259ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
20260 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20261 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
20262 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
20263 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020264
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020265ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020266 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
20267 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20268 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020269 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020270 does not support resumed sessions.
20271
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020272ssl_c_der : binary
20273 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
20274 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20275 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020277ssl_c_err : integer
20278 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20279 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
20280 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
20281 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20282 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020283
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020284ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020285 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20286 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20287 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20288 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20289 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20290 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20291 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20292 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020293 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20294 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20295 LDAP v3.
20296 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20297 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020299ssl_c_key_alg : string
20300 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20301 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20302 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020303
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020304ssl_c_notafter : string
20305 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
20306 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20307 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020020308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020309ssl_c_notbefore : string
20310 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
20311 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20312 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020313
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020314ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020315 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20316 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20317 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20318 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20319 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20320 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20321 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20322 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020323 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20324 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20325 LDAP v3.
20326 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20327 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020328
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020329ssl_c_serial : binary
20330 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
20331 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20332 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020334ssl_c_sha1 : binary
20335 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
20336 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
20337 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020338 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
20339 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
20340
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020341 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020342 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020344ssl_c_sig_alg : string
20345 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20346 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20347 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020349ssl_c_used : boolean
20350 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
20351 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020352
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020353ssl_c_verify : integer
20354 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
20355 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
20356 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
20357 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020358
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020359ssl_c_version : integer
20360 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
20361 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020362
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010020363ssl_f_der : binary
20364 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
20365 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20366 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20367
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020368ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020369 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20370 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20371 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20372 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020373 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020374 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20375 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20376 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020377 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20378 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20379 LDAP v3.
20380 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20381 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020383ssl_f_key_alg : string
20384 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20385 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
20386 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020387
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020388ssl_f_notafter : string
20389 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20390 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20391 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020392
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020393ssl_f_notbefore : string
20394 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
20395 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20396 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020397
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020398ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020399 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20400 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20401 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20402 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20403 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20404 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20405 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20406 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020407 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20408 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20409 LDAP v3.
20410 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20411 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020412
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020413ssl_f_serial : binary
20414 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20415 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20416 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020417
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020020418ssl_f_sha1 : binary
20419 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
20420 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20421 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20422
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020423ssl_f_sig_alg : string
20424 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20425 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20426 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020428ssl_f_version : integer
20429 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
20430 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20431
20432ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020433 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20434 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
20435 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
20436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020437 Example :
20438 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
20439 listen http-https
20440 bind :80
20441 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
20442 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
20443
20444ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
20445 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
20446 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
20447
20448ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020449 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020450 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020451 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020452 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20453 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20454 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
20455 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
20456 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
20457 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
20458
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020459ssl_fc_cipher : string
20460 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
20461 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020020462
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020463ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20464 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
20465 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020466 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020467 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20468 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20469 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020470
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020471 Example:
20472 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20473 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20474 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20475 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20476 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20477 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20478 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20479 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20480 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20481
20482ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020483 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020484 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020485 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
20486 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020487 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20488 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020489
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020490ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020491 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020492 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020493 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020494 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20495 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
20496 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20497 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
20498 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
20499 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020500
20501ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020502 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020503 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
20504 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020505
20506ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
20507 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
20508 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020509 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020510
20511 Example:
20512 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20513 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20514 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20515 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20516 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20517 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20518 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20519 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20520 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20521
20522ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20523 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
20524 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020525 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020526 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20527 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
20528 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20529
20530 Example:
20531 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20532 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20533 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20534 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20535 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20536 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20537 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20538 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20539 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20540
20541ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
20542 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
20543 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020544 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020545 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
20546 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
20547 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
20548
20549 Example:
20550 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20551 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20552 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20553 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20554 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20555 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20556 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20557 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20558 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010020559
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020560ssl_fc_client_random : binary
20561 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20562 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20563 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20564
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020565ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
20566 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20567 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20568 transport layer.
20569 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20570 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20571 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20572 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20573
20574ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20575 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20576 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20577 transport layer.
20578 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20579 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20580 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20581 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20582
20583ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
20584 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20585 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20586 transport layer.
20587 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20588 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20589 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20590 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20591
20592ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
20593 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20594 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20595 transport layer.
20596 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20597 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20598 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20599 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20600
20601ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
20602 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20603 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20604 transport layer.
20605 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20606 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20607 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20608 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20609
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020610ssl_fc_err : integer
20611 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20612 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20613 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
20614 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
20615 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
20616 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
20617 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
20618 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
20619 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
20620 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
20621 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
20622 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20623 codes.
20624
20625ssl_fc_err_str : string
20626 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20627 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20628 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
20629 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
20630 also "ssl_fc_err".
20631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020632ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020633 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
20634 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010020635 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
20636 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
20637 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
20638 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020639
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020020640ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
20641 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
20642 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
20643 wait until the handshake happened.
20644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020645ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
20646 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020647 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
20648 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020649 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020020650 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020651
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020020652ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020653 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010020654 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
20655 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020020656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020657ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020658 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020659 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020660 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
20661 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
20662 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
20663 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
20664 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
20665 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020020666
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020667ssl_fc_protocol : string
20668 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
20669 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020670
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020671ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
20672 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
20673 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020020674 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
20675 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020020676
20677 Example:
20678 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
20679 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20680 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20681 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
20682 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
20683 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
20684 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
20685 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
20686 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
20687
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020688ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020689 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020690 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010020691 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040020692
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020020693ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
20694 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
20695 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
20696 transport layer.
20697 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20698 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20699 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20700 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20701
20702ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
20703 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
20704 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
20705 transport layer.
20706 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
20707 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
20708 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
20709 "tune.ssl.keylog"
20710
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020711ssl_fc_server_random : binary
20712 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
20713 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20714 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
20715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020716ssl_fc_session_id : binary
20717 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
20718 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
20719 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
20720 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020020721
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020722ssl_fc_session_key : binary
20723 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
20724 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20725 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
20726 BoringSSL.
20727
20728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020729ssl_fc_sni : string
20730 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
20731 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020732 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020733 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
20734 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
20735
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020020736 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020737 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020738 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020739 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020020740 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020741
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010020742 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
20743 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
20744 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
20745 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
20746 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
20747 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
20748 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
20749 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
20750 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
20751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020752 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020753 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
20754 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020020755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020756ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
20757 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
20758 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020759
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020760ssl_s_der : binary
20761 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
20762 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20763 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20764
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020765ssl_s_chain_der : binary
20766 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
20767 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20768 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020769 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020770 does not support resumed sessions.
20771
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020772ssl_s_key_alg : string
20773 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20774 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
20775 SSL/TLS transport layer.
20776
20777ssl_s_notafter : string
20778 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
20779 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20780 transport layer.
20781
20782ssl_s_notbefore : string
20783 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
20784 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20785 transport layer.
20786
20787ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20788 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20789 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20790 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20791 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20792 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20793 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020794 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20795 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020796 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20797 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20798 LDAP v3.
20799 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20800 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20801
20802ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20803 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20804 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20805 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20806 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20807 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20808 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020020809 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20810 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020020811 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20812 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20813 LDAP v3.
20814 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20815 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20816
20817ssl_s_serial : binary
20818 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
20819 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20820 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20821
20822ssl_s_sha1 : binary
20823 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
20824 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
20825 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
20826
20827ssl_s_sig_alg : string
20828 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20829 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20830 layer.
20831
20832ssl_s_version : integer
20833 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
20834 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020835
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200208367.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020837------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020020838
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020839Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
20840sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
20841only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
20842For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
20843be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
20844can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
20845sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
20846for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
20847content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020848
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020849Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
20850 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020851 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010020852 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
20853 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
20854 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
20855 sample expression). So be careful.
20856
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010020857distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
20858 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
20859 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
20860 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
20861 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
20862 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
20863 list of supported tokens.
20864
20865distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
20866 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
20867 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
20868 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
20869 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
20870 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
20871 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
20872 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
20873 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
20874 supported tokens.
20875
20876 Example :
20877 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
20878 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
20879 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
20880 # send large files to the big farm
20881 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
20882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020883payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020884 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020885 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
20886 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020888payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
20889 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020890 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020891 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020892
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020893req.len : integer
20894req_len : integer (deprecated)
20895 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
20896 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
20897 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
20898 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
20899 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020900 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020901 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
20902 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020904req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
20905 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020020906 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
20907 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
20908 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
20909 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020910
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020911 ACL derivatives :
20912 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020914req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
20915 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
20916 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
20917 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
20918 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020919
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020920 ACL derivatives :
20921 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020923 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020925req.proto_http : boolean
20926req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
20927 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
20928 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
20929 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
20930 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
20931 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
20932 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
20933 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020934
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020935 Example:
20936 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
20937 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
20938 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020939 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020020940
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020941req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
20942rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20943 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
20944 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
20945 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
20946 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
20947 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
20948 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
20949 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020951 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
20952 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
20953 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
20954 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
20955 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
20956 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020958 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020959 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020960
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020961 Example :
20962 listen tse-farm
20963 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
20964 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
20965 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
20966 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
20967 # apply RDP cookie persistence
20968 persist rdp-cookie
20969 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
20970 # This is only useful makes sense if
20971 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
20972 stick-table type string size 204800
20973 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
20974 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
20975 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020977 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020978 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020980req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
20981rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
20982 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
20983 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
20984 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
20985 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020987 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010020988 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020020989
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020990req.ssl_alpn : string
20991 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
20992 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
20993 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
20994 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
20995 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
20996 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020020997 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110020998
20999 Examples :
21000 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21001 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021002 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021003 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021004 default_backend bk_default
21005
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021006req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21007 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21008 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021009 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21010 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21011 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21012 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21013 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021014
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021015req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21016req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21017 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21018 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21019 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21020 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21021 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21022 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21023 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021025req.ssl_sni : string
21026req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21027 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21028 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21029 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21030 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21031 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021032 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21033 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21034 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21035 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21036 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21037 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21038 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21039 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21040 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021041
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021042 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021043 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021045 Examples :
21046 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21047 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021048 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021049 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021050 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021051
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021052req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21053 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21054 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21055 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21056 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21057 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21058 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21059 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21060 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21061 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021063req.ssl_ver : integer
21064req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21065 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21066 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21067 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21068 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21069 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21070 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21071 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021072 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021073 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021075 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021076 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021077
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021078res.len : integer
21079 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21080 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21081 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21082 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21083 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021084 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021085 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021086 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021088res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21089 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021090 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021091 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021092 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021093 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021095res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21096 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21097 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21098 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021099 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21100 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021101
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021102 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021103
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021104res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21105rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21106 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21107 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21108 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21109 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21110 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21111 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21112 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021114wait_end : boolean
21115 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21116 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021117 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021118 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21119 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021120 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021121 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21122 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021124 Examples :
21125 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21126 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21127 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021129 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21130 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21131 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21132 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21133 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21134 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21135 tcp-request content reject
21136
21137
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200211387.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021139--------------------------------------
21140
21141It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21142This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21143data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21144its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21145HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21146content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21147to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21148more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21149response are indexed.
21150
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021151Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21152 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21153 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21154 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21155 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21156 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21157 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021159base : string
21160 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21161 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21162 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21163 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21164 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21165 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21166 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21167 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21168
21169 ACL derivatives :
21170 base : exact string match
21171 base_beg : prefix match
21172 base_dir : subdir match
21173 base_dom : domain match
21174 base_end : suffix match
21175 base_len : length match
21176 base_reg : regex match
21177 base_sub : substring match
21178
21179base32 : integer
21180 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21181 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21182 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021183 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21184 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21185 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021186
21187base32+src : binary
21188 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21189 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21190 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21191 per-URL counters.
21192
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021193baseq : string
21194 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21195 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21196 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21197 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21198
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021199capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21200 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21201 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21202 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21203
21204capture.req.method : string
21205 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21206 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21207 because it's allocated.
21208
21209capture.req.uri : string
21210 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21211 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21212 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21213 allocated.
21214
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021215capture.req.ver : string
21216 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21217 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21218 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21219
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021220capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21221 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21222 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21223 The first entry is an index of 0.
21224 See also: "capture response header"
21225
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021226capture.res.ver : string
21227 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21228 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21229 persistent flag.
21230
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021231req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021232 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
21233 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
21234 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021235
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021236req.body_param([<name>) : string
21237 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
21238 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
21239 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
21240 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
21241 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
21242 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
21243 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
21244 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
21245 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
21246 given.
21247
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021248req.body_len : integer
21249 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
21250 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021251 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
21252 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021253
21254req.body_size : integer
21255 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021256 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21257 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021259req.cook([<name>]) : string
21260cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21261 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21262 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
21263 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
21264 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
21265 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
21266 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
21267 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
21268 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
21269
21270 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021271 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
21272 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
21273 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
21274 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
21275 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
21276 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
21277 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
21278 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021280req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21281cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21282 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21283 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021285req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21286cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21287 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21288 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
21289 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
21290 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021292cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21293 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21294 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
21295 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
21296 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021297 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021298 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
21299 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
21300 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
21301 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021303hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21304 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
21305 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
21306 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
21307 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021308 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021309
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021310req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021311 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
21312 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
21313 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
21314 with headers such as User-Agent.
21315
21316 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21317 found.
21318
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021319 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21320 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21321 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021322 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021323
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021324req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21325 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21326 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021327 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
21328 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021329
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021330req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021331 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
21332 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
21333 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
21334 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
21335 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
21336 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
21337 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
21338
21339 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21340 found.
21341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021342 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21343 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21344 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021345 with -1 being the last one.
21346
21347 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
21348 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021350 ACL derivatives :
21351 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21352 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21353 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21354 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21355 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21356 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21357 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21358 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
21359
21360req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21361hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
21362 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21363 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021364 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
21365 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
21366 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
21367
21368 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
21369 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
21370 which contain more than one of certain headers.
21371
21372 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021373
21374req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21375hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
21376 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
21377 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
21378 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010021379 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
21380 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
21381 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
21382 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
21383 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021384
21385 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21386
21387 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021388
21389req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21390hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
21391 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
21392 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
21393 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021394
21395 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
21396
21397 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021398
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021399req.hdrs : string
21400 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
21401 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21402 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
21403 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21404
21405req.hdrs_bin : binary
21406 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21407 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
21408 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
21409 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
21410 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
21411 names and values (length of 0 for both).
21412
21413 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021414
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010021415 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21416 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010021417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021418http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
21419 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
21420 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
21421 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21422 basic auth is supported.
21423
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020021424http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
21425 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
21426 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
21427 performed on the data sent by the client.
21428 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
21429 Authorization one.
21430
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021431http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
21432 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
21433 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
21434 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
21435 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021436 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
21437 basic auth is supported.
21438
21439 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010021440 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
21441 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
21442 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
21443 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021444
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021445http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021446 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
21447 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21448 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021449
21450http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021451 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
21452 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
21453 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021454
21455http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010021456 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
21457 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
21458 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020021459
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021460http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021461 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
21462 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021463 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
21464 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020021465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021466method : integer + string
21467 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
21468 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
21469 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
21470 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
21471 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
21472 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
21473 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021474
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021475 ACL derivatives :
21476 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021477
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021478 Example :
21479 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
21480 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
21481 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021483path : string
21484 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
21485 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
21486 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
21487 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
21488 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021489 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021490 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021492 ACL derivatives :
21493 path : exact string match
21494 path_beg : prefix match
21495 path_dir : subdir match
21496 path_dom : domain match
21497 path_end : suffix match
21498 path_len : length match
21499 path_reg : regex match
21500 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021501
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020021502pathq : string
21503 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
21504 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
21505 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
21506 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
21507 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
21508 result in both cases.
21509
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021510query : string
21511 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
21512 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
21513 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
21514 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021515 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010021516 which stops before the question mark.
21517
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021518req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21519 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21520 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21521 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
21522 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21523
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021524req.ver : string
21525req_ver : string (deprecated)
21526 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
21527 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
21528 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021530 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021531 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021532
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021533res.body : binary
21534 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
21535 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021536 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21537
21538 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021539
21540res.body_len : integer
21541 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
21542 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021543 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21544
21545 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021546
21547res.body_size : integer
21548 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
21549 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21550 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
21551 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021552 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
21553
21554 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021555
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010021556res.cache_hit : boolean
21557 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
21558 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
21559
21560res.cache_name : string
21561 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
21562 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
21563 empty string.
21564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021565res.comp : boolean
21566 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
21567 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
21568 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021570res.comp_algo : string
21571 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
21572 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
21573 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021574
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021575res.cook([<name>]) : string
21576scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21577 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21578 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021579 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21580
21581 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021583 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021584 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020021585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021586res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21587scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21588 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21589 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021590 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
21591
21592 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021593
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021594res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21595scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21596 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21597 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021598 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
21599
21600 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021602res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021603 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21604 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21605
21606 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
21607 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
21608
21609 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
21610
21611 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021613res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021614 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21615 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21616
21617 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
21618 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
21619
21620 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021622res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21623shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021624 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
21625 on the headers within an HTTP response.
21626
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021627 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021628 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
21629
21630 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021632 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021633 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21634 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21635 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21636 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21637 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21638 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21639 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21640 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021641
21642res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21643shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021644 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
21645 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21646
21647 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050021648 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021649
21650 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021652res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
21653shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021654 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
21655 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21656
21657 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21658
21659 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020021660
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021661res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
21662 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
21663 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
21664 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021665 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
21666
21667 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010021668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021669res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
21670shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021671 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
21672 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
21673
21674 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
21675
21676 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021677
21678res.hdrs : string
21679 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
21680 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
21681 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021682 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
21683
21684 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021685
21686res.hdrs_bin : binary
21687 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
21688 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
21689 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
21690 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
21691 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
21692 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
21693 (length of 0 for both).
21694
21695 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
21696
21697 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
21698 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021700res.ver : string
21701resp_ver : string (deprecated)
21702 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021703 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
21704
21705 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021707 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021708 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010021709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021710set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21711 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
21712 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021713 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021714 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021716 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
21717 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010021718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021719status : integer
21720 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
21721 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021722 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
21723
21724 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021725
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020021726unique-id : string
21727 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
21728 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
21729 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
21730 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
21731 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
21732 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
21733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021734url : string
21735 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
21736 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
21737 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
21738 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
21739 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
21740 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
21741 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021743 ACL derivatives :
21744 url : exact string match
21745 url_beg : prefix match
21746 url_dir : subdir match
21747 url_dom : domain match
21748 url_end : suffix match
21749 url_len : length match
21750 url_reg : regex match
21751 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021753url_ip : ip
21754 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
21755 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
21756 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
21757 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021758 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
21759 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021761url_port : integer
21762 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020021763 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021764
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021765urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
21766url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021767 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
21768 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021769 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
21770 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
21771 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
21772 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021773 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
21774 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020021775 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
21776 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021778 ACL derivatives :
21779 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
21780 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
21781 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
21782 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
21783 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
21784 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
21785 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
21786 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021787
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021789 Example :
21790 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
21791 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
21792 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
21793 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020021794
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030021795urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021796 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
21797 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
21798 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020021799
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020021800url32 : integer
21801 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
21802 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
21803 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
21804 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
21805 is an unsigned integer.
21806
21807url32+src : binary
21808 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
21809 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
21810 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
21811
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020021812
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200218137.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021814---------------------------------------
21815
21816This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
21817used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
21818purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
21819There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
21820or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
21821any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
21822for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
21823
21824internal.htx.data : integer
21825 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
21826 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21827
21828internal.htx.free : integer
21829 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
21830 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21831
21832internal.htx.free_data : integer
21833 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
21834 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21835
21836internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010021837 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
21838 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
21839 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021840
21841internal.htx.nbblks : integer
21842 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
21843 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21844
21845internal.htx.size : integer
21846 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
21847 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21848
21849internal.htx.used : integer
21850 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
21851 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21852 direction.
21853
21854internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
21855 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21856 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
21857 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
21858 of the special value :
21859 * head : The oldest inserted block
21860 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021861 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021862
21863internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
21864 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21865 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
21866 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
21867 integer or one of the special value :
21868 * head : The oldest inserted block
21869 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021870 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021871
21872internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
21873 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
21874 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
21875 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
21876 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21877
21878 * head : The oldest inserted block
21879 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021880 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021881
21882internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
21883 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21884 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21885 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21886 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21887
21888 * head : The oldest inserted block
21889 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021890 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021891
21892internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
21893 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
21894 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
21895 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21896 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21897
21898 * head : The oldest inserted block
21899 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021900 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021901
21902internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
21903 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
21904 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
21905 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
21906 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
21907
21908 * head : The oldest inserted block
21909 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021910 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010021911
21912internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
21913 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
21914 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
21915 it returns false.
21916
21917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200219187.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021919---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021921Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
21922every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020021923order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021924
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021925ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021926---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
21927FALSE always_false never match
21928HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
21929HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
21930HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010021931HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021932HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
21933HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
21934HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
21935HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020021936LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020021937METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
21938METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
21939METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
21940METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
21941METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
21942METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
21943METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
21944METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
21945RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
21946REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
21947TRUE always_true always match
21948WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
21949---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010021950
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010021951
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219528. Logging
21953----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021954
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021955One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
21956provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
21957very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
21958provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
21959state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021960to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021961headers.
21962
21963In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
21964about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
21965send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
21966
21967 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
21968 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
21969 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
21970 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
21971 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021972 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060021973 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021974
21975The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
21976allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
21977as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
21978while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
21979real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
21980delay.
21981
21982
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219838.1. Log levels
21984---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021985
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021986TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021987source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021988HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
21989in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
21990track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
21991syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
21992about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021993
21994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219958.2. Log formats
21996----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021997
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021998HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090021999and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22000slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22001options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022002
22003 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22004 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22005 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22006 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22007 extents.
22008
22009 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22010 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22011 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22012 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22013 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22014
22015 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22016 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22017 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22018 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22019 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22020
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022021 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22022 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22023 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22024 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22025
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022026 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22027
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022028Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22029specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22030field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22031servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22032always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22033identifier.
22034
22035Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22036 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22037 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22038 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22039 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22040
22041
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220428.2.1. Default log format
22043-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022044
22045This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22046as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22047format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22048
22049 Example :
22050 listen www
22051 mode http
22052 log global
22053 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22054
22055 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22056 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22057 (www/HTTP)
22058
22059 Field Format Extract from the example above
22060 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22061 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22062 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22063 4 'to' to
22064 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22065 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22066
22067Detailed fields description :
22068 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22069 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22070 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22071 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22072 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22073 and processed the connection.
22074 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22075
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022076In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22077"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22078connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22079
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022080It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22081will eventually disappear.
22082
22083
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220848.2.2. TCP log format
22085---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022086
22087The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22088is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22089information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22090counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22091emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22092environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22093the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22094sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022095specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022096not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22097
22098The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22099exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022100if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22101Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022102
22103 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22104 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22105 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022106 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22107 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022108
22109A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22110are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022111
22112 Example :
22113 frontend fnt
22114 mode tcp
22115 option tcplog
22116 log global
22117 default_backend bck
22118
22119 backend bck
22120 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22121
22122 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22123 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22124 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22125
22126 Field Format Extract from the example above
22127 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22128 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22129 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22130 4 frontend_name fnt
22131 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22132 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22133 7 bytes_read* 212
22134 8 termination_state --
22135 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22136 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22137
22138Detailed fields description :
22139 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022140 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022141 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22142 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022143 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022144 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022145 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022146
22147 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022148 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22149 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22150 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022151
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022152 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022153 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22154 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022155 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22156 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22157 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22158 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022159
22160 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22161 and processed the connection.
22162
22163 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22164 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22165 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22166 applications.
22167
22168 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22169 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22170 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22171 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22172 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22173
22174 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22175 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22176 See "Timers" below for more details.
22177
22178 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22179 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22180 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22181 "Timers" below for more details.
22182
22183 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022184 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022185 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22186 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22187 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22188 details.
22189
22190 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22191 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22192 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22193 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22194 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22195
22196 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22197 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22198 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22199 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22200 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22201 for more details.
22202
22203 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022204 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022205 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22206 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22207 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022208 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022209
22210 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22211 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22212 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22213 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22214 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22215 caused by a denial of service attack.
22216
22217 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22218 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22219 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22220 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22221 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22222 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22223 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22224 denial of service attack.
22225
22226 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22227 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22228 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22229 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22230 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22231 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22232 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22233 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
22234 be processed than on other servers.
22235
22236 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22237 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22238 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22239 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022240 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022241 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22242 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22243 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22244 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22245 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22246 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22247 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22248 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22249
22250 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22251 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22252 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22253 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22254 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22255 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022256 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022257 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22258
22259 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22260 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22261 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22262 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22263 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22264 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022265 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022266 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22267 occurs.
22268
22269
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222708.2.3. HTTP log format
22271----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022272
22273The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
22274is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
22275the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
22276are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
22277emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
22278generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
22279"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
22280which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022281frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
22282is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022283
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022284The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22285exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022286if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22287instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022288
22289 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
22290 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22291 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
22292
22293And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
22294this exact string:
22295
22296 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
22297 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
22298 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
22299 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022300 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
22301 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022302
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022303Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
22304slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
22305with a star ('*') after the field name below.
22306
22307 Example :
22308 frontend http-in
22309 mode http
22310 option httplog
22311 log global
22312 default_backend bck
22313
22314 backend static
22315 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22316
22317 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22318 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
22319 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022320 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022321
22322 Field Format Extract from the example above
22323 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22324 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022325 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022326 4 frontend_name http-in
22327 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022328 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022329 7 status_code 200
22330 8 bytes_read* 2750
22331 9 captured_request_cookie -
22332 10 captured_response_cookie -
22333 11 termination_state ----
22334 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22335 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22336 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22337 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22338 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022339
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022340Detailed fields description :
22341 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022342 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022343 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22344 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022345 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022346 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022347 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022348
22349 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022350 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22351 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22352 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022353
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022354 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022355 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022356
22357 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22358 and processed the connection.
22359
22360 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22361 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22362 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
22363
22364 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22365 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22366 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22367 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
22368 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
22369 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
22370
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022371 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
22372 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
22373 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022374 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022375 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
22376 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022377 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022378 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022379
22380 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22381 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022382 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022383
22384 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22385 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022386 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
22387 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022388
22389 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
22390 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
22391 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
22392 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
22393 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022394 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
22395 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022396
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022397 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022398 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
22399 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
22400 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
22401 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
22402 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
22403 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022404 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022405
22406 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022407 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
22408 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022409
22410 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
22411 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022412 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022413 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
22414 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
22415 overflowing.
22416
22417 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
22418 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
22419 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
22420 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
22421 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
22422 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
22423 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
22424 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22425
22426 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
22427 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
22428 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
22429 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
22430 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
22431 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
22432 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
22433 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
22434
22435 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22436 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22437 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
22438 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
22439 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
22440 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
22441 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
22442
22443 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022444 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022445 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
22446 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
22447 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022448 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022449 system.
22450
22451 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22452 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22453 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22454 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22455 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22456 caused by a denial of service attack.
22457
22458 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22459 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22460 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22461 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22462 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22463 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22464 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22465 denial of service attack.
22466
22467 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22468 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22469 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22470 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22471 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22472 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22473 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22474 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
22475 processed than on other servers.
22476
22477 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22478 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22479 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22480 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022481 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022482 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22483 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22484 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22485 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22486 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22487 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22488 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22489 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22490
22491 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22492 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22493 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22494 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22495 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22496 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022497 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022498 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22499
22500 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22501 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22502 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22503 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22504 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22505 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022506 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022507 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22508 occurs.
22509
22510 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
22511 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
22512 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
22513 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
22514 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
22515 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
22516 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
22517 cookies" below for more details.
22518
22519 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
22520 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
22521 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
22522 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
22523 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
22524 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
22525 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
22526 and cookies" below for more details.
22527
22528 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
22529 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
22530 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
22531 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
22532 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
22533 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
22534 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
22535 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
22536
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022537
225388.2.4. HTTPS log format
22539----------------------
22540
22541The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
22542extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
22543information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
22544frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
22545end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
22546matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
22547sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
22548dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
22549"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22550
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022551The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22552exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022553if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22554instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022555
22556 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
22557 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22558 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
22559 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022560 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022561 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
22562 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022563
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022564This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
22565appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
22566HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022567
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022568 Example :
22569 frontend https-in
22570 mode http
22571 option httpslog
22572 log global
22573 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
22574 default_backend bck
22575
22576 backend static
22577 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
22578
22579 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22580 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
22581 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022582 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
22583 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022584
22585 Field Format Extract from the example above
22586 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22587 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
22588 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
22589 4 frontend_name https-in
22590 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
22591 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
22592 7 status_code 200
22593 8 bytes_read* 2750
22594 9 captured_request_cookie -
22595 10 captured_response_cookie -
22596 11 termination_state ----
22597 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22598 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22599 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22600 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22601 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022602 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022603 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022604 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
22605 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022606
22607Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010022608 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
22609 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
22610 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022611
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022612 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
22613 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
22614 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050022615 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020022616 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022617
22618 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
22619 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
22620 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
22621 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
22622
22623 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
22624 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
22625 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
22626 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
22627
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020022628 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
22629 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
22630 can be shared by multiple requests.
22631
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010022632 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
22633 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
22634 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
22635 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
22636 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
22637
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020022638 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
22639
22640 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
22641
22642
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100226438.2.5. Error log format
22644-----------------------
22645
22646When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
22647protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
22648unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
22649line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
22650"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
22651will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
22652logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
22653
22654The default format looks like this :
22655
22656 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
22657 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
22658 Connection error during SSL handshake
22659
22660 Field Format Extract from the example above
22661 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
22662 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
22663 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
22664 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
22665 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
22666
22667These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
22668failures.
22669
22670By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
22671above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
22672defined format.
22673
22674An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
22675source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
22676number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
22677internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
22678error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
22679the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
22680certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
22681indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
22682indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
22683ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
22684are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
22685would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
22686regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
22687
22688 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010022689 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010022690 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
22691 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
22692
22693
226948.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022695------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022696
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022697When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
22698ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
22699a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
22700formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
22701looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
22702and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022703
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022704HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022705Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
22706separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
22707prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
22708
22709Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
22710variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022711("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022712
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022713If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020022714as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010022715less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
22716the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
22717
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020022718Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
22719"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
22720delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
22721preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022722
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022723Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
22724'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
22725https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
22726such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
22727
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022728Flags are :
22729 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022730 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022731 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
22732 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022733
22734 Example:
22735
22736 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
22737 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
22738
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010022739 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
22740
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022741Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
22742
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022743 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022744 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022745 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
22746 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
22747 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022748 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
22749 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
22750 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022751 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022752 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000022753 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000022754 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000022755 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000022756 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
22757 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010022758 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020022759 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022760 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010022761 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022762 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020022763 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080022764 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022765 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
22766 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
22767 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
22768 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
22769 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022770 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022771 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022772 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022773 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022774 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022775 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
22776 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022777 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22778 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
22779 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022780 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022781 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
22782 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022783 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022784 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
22785 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
22786 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020022787 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020022788 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022789 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
22790 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
22791 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
22792 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020022793 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020022794 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022795 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022796 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010022797 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022798 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022799 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
22800 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
22801 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022802 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022803 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
22804 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010022805 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022806 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
22807 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020022808 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022809 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022810 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010022811 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022812
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020022813 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022814
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010022815
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228168.3. Advanced logging options
22817-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022818
22819Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
22820just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
22821options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
22822for more information about their usage.
22823
22824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228258.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
22826------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022827
22828It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022829HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022830commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
22831monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
22832ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
22833
22834 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
22835 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
22836 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
22837 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
22838
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020022839 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
22840 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022841
22842 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
22843 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
22844 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
22845
22846
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228478.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
22848----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022849
22850The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
22851what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
22852or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022853"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022854just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
22855log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
22856after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
22857is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
22858with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
22859with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
22860
22861
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228628.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
22863------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022864
22865Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
22866for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
22867"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
22868retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
22869raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
22870a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
22871file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
22872you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
22873"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
22874
22875
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228768.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
22877--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022878
22879Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
22880multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
22881them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
22882"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
22883logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
22884error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
22885and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
22886too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
22887useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
22888alternative.
22889
22890
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228918.4. Timing events
22892------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022893
22894Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
22895reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
22896the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
22897frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022898mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
22899addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
22900
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022901Timings events in HTTP mode:
22902
22903 first request 2nd request
22904 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
22905 t tr t tr ...
22906 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
22907 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
22908 :<---- Tq ---->: :
22909 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000022910 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010022911 :<--------- Ta --------->:
22912
22913Timings events in TCP mode:
22914
22915 TCP session
22916 |<----------------->|
22917 t t
22918 ---|----|----|----|----|---
22919 | Th Tw Tc Td |
22920 |<------ Tt ------->|
22921
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022922 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022923 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022924 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
22925 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
22926 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022927 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022928 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
22929 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
22930 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
22931 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022932
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022933 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
22934 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
22935 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022936 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
22937 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
22938 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
22939 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
22940 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
22941 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022942
22943 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
22944 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
22945 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
22946 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
22947 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
22948 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
22949 request typed by hand during a test.
22950
22951 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
22952 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022953 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022954 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
22955 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
22956 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
22957 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022958
22959 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
22960 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
22961 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
22962 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
22963 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
22964
22965 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
22966 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
22967 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
22968 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
22969 connection never established.
22970
22971 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
22972 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
22973 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
22974 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
22975 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
22976 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
22977 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
22978 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
22979 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
22980 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
22981 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
22982
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022983 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
22984 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
22985 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
22986 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
22987 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
22988 by subtracting other timers when valid :
22989
22990 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
22991
22992 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
22993 "Ta" can never be negative.
22994
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022995 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
22996 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022997 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
22998 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022999 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023000
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023001 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023002
23003 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023004 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23005 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023006
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023007 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23008 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23009 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23010 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23011 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23012 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23013 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23014 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23015
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023016These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23017protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23018that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023019due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23020"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23021that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023022
23023Most common cases :
23024
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023025 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23026 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23027 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23028 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23029 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023030 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023031 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23032 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23033 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23034 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23035 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023036 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023037
23038 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23039 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23040 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23041 of ms on remote networks.
23042
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023043 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23044 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23045 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023046
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023047 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23048 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023049 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023050 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23051 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23052 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23053 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23054 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23055 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023056
23057Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23058
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023059 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023060 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023061 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023062
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023063 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023064 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23065 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23066
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023067 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023068 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23069 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23070 flags.
23071
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023072 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23073 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023074 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23075 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23076 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23077 the client connection was maintained open.
23078
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023079 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023080 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023081 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023082 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23083
23084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200230858.5. Session state at disconnection
23086-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023087
23088TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23089"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
230902-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23091each of which has a special meaning :
23092
23093 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23094 session to terminate :
23095
23096 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23097
23098 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23099 server explicitly refused it.
23100
23101 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23102 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23103 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23104 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023105 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023106
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023107 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023108 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023109
23110 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23111 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23112 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23113 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23114 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23115
23116 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23117 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23118 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23119 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23120 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23121
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023122 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023123 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23124
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023125 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023126 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23127 backup connections when going up.
23128
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023129 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023130
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023131 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23132 send or receive data.
23133
23134 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23135 send or receive data.
23136
23137 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23138 with nothing left in the buffers.
23139
23140 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23141
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023142 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023143 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23144
23145 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23146 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23147 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23148 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23149 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23150
23151 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23152 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23153
23154 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23155 server (HTTP only).
23156
23157 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23158
23159 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23160 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23161 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23162
23163 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23164 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23165 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23166
23167 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23168
23169 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23170 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23171
23172 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23173 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23174 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23175
23176 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23177 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023178 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23179 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023180
23181 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23182 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23183 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23184 another server.
23185
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023186 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023187 server.
23188
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023189 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23190 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23191 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23192 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23193
23194 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23195 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23196 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23197 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23198
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023199 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23200 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23201 "use-server" rule).
23202
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023203 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23204
23205 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23206 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
23207
23208 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
23209
23210 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
23211 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
23212 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
23213
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023214 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
23215 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023216 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023217 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
23218 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
23219
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023220 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
23221
23222 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
23223 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
23224
23225 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
23226
23227 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23228
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023229The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
23230was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023231helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
23232starvation, attacks, etc...
23233
23234The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
23235alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
23236easier finding and understanding.
23237
23238 Flags Reason
23239
23240 -- Normal termination.
23241
23242 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023243 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
23244 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023245 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
23246
23247 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
23248 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023249 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
23250 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023251 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
23252 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023253
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023254 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23255 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023256 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023257
23258 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
23259 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
23260 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
23261
23262 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
23263 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
23264 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
23265 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
23266 the server takes too long to respond.
23267
23268 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
23269 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
23270 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
23271 long a time to respond.
23272
23273 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
23274 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
23275 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023276 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023277 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
23278 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023279
23280 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
23281 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
23282 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
23283 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
23284 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020023285 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023286 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
23287 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
23288 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
23289 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
23290 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
23291 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
23292 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
23293 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023294 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023295 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
23296 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
23297 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023298
23299 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
23300 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023301 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
23302 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
23303 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
23304 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023305
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023306 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023307 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
23308
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023309 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023310 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
23311 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023312 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023313 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
23314 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
23315
23316 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
23317 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
23318 503 or 504 here.
23319
23320 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023321 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023322 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
23323 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
23324 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
23325
23326 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23327 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023328 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023329 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023330 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023331
23332 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
23333 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
23334 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
23335 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
23336 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
23337 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023338 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023339
23340 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
23341 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
23342 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
23343 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
23344 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
23345 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
23346 solution is to fix the application.
23347
23348 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
23349 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
23350 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
23351 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
23352 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
23353 external attacks.
23354
23355 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070023356 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023357 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023358 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
23359 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
23360
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023361 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
23362 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
23363 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023364 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020023365 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023366
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023367 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
23368 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
23369 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
23370 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010023371 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
23372 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
23373 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
23374 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023375 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
23376 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
23377 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
23378 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023379
23380 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
23381 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
23382 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020023383 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
23384 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
23385 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
23386 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023387
23388 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
23389 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
23390 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
23391 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
23392
23393 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
23394 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
23395 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
23396 only be solved by proper system tuning.
23397
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023398The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023399persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023400important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
23401re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
23402
23403 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
23404
23405 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23406 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
23407 set on a GET request.
23408
23409 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
23410 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023411 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023412 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
23413
23414 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
23415 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
23416 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
23417
23418 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
23419 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
23420 already got a cookie.
23421
23422 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23423 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
23424 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
23425 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
23426 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
23427
23428 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
23429 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23430 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23431
23432 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
23433 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
23434 new cookie was inserted in the response.
23435
23436 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
23437 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
23438
23439 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
23440 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
23441 then advertised in the response.
23442
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023443
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234448.6. Non-printable characters
23445-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023446
23447In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
23448consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
23449converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
23450prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
23451being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
23452escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
23453is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
23454'}' when logging headers.
23455
23456Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
23457issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
23458containing spaces is "User-Agent".
23459
23460Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
23461the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
23462performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
23463
23464
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234658.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
23466---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023467
23468Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
23469achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023470section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023471cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
23472the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
23473the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023474locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023475not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
23476user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
23477a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
23478wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
23479
23480 Examples :
23481 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
23482 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
23483
23484 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
23485 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
23486
23487
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234888.8. Capturing HTTP headers
23489---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023490
23491Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
23492proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
23493the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
23494server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
23495
23496Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
23497response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023498section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023499
23500It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023501time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
23502appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023503are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
23504and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
23505follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
23506request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
23507in the logs.
23508
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023509As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
23510frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
23511an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
23512
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023513 Example :
23514 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
23515 listen proxy-out
23516 mode http
23517 option httplog
23518 option logasap
23519 log global
23520 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
23521
23522 # log the name of the virtual server
23523 capture request header Host len 20
23524
23525 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
23526 capture request header Content-Length len 10
23527
23528 # log the beginning of the referrer
23529 capture request header Referer len 20
23530
23531 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
23532 capture response header Server len 20
23533
23534 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
23535 capture response header Content-Length len 10
23536
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023537 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023538 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
23539
23540 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
23541 capture response header Via len 20
23542
23543 # log the URL location during a redirection
23544 capture response header Location len 20
23545
23546 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
23547 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
23548 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23549 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
23550 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
23551
23552 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23553 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23554 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23555 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023556 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023557
23558 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
23559 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
23560 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
23561 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
23562 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023563 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023564
23565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235668.9. Examples of logs
23567---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023568
23569These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
23570them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
23571reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
23572
23573 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
23574 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23575 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23576
23577 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
23578 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
23579
23580 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
23581 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
23582 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
23583
23584 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
23585 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
23586
23587 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
23588 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
23589 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
23590
23591 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010023592 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023593 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
23594 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
23595
23596 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
23597 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
23598 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
23599
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023600 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
23601 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
23602 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
23603 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023604 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020023605 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023606
23607 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023608 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023609
23610 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
23611 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
23612 Nothing was sent to any server.
23613
23614 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
23615 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
23616
23617 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
23618 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023619 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023620 send a 408 return code to the client.
23621
23622 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
23623 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
23624
23625 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
23626 5 seconds ("c----").
23627
23628 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
23629 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023630 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023631
23632 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023633 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023634 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
23635 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
23636 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
23637 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
23638 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010023639
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020023640
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200236419. Supported filters
23642--------------------
23643
23644Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
23645accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
23646unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
23647
23648See also : "filter"
23649
236509.1. Trace
23651----------
23652
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010023653filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023654
23655 Arguments:
23656 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
23657 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
23658
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010023659 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023660
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023661 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023662 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
23663 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
23664 amount of the parsed data.
23665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023666 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010023667
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023668This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
23669callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
23670information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
23671filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
23672
23673Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
23674tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
23675a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
23676
23677
236789.2. HTTP compression
23679---------------------
23680
23681filter compression
23682
23683The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
23684keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023685when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
23686fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
23687done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
23688explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
23689filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
23690listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23691order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023692
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023693See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
23694 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020023695
23696
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200236979.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
23698--------------------------------------------
23699
23700filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
23701
23702 Arguments :
23703
23704 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
23705 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
23706 parsed.
23707
23708 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
23709 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
23710 part must be placed in its own scope.
23711
23712The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
23713external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023714streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023715exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
23716also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
23717
23718SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
23719the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
23720
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010023721For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020023722"doc/SPOE.txt".
23723
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100237249.4. Cache
23725----------
23726
23727filter cache <name>
23728
23729 Arguments :
23730
23731 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
23732
23733The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
23734"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023735cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023736other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
23737case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
23738is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
23739filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010023740listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23741order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010023742
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023743See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
23744 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
23745
23746
237479.5. Fcgi-app
23748-------------
23749
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040023750filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023751
23752 Arguments :
23753
23754 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
23755
23756The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
23757request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
23758reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
23759used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
23760implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
23761used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
23762fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
23763used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
23764order.
23765
23766See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
23767 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
23768
23769
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100237709.6. OpenTracing
23771----------------
23772
23773The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
23774HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
23775of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
23776Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
23777
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023778This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023779
23780The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
23781HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
23782participates in the work of HAProxy.
23783
23784filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
23785
23786 Arguments :
23787
23788 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
23789 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
23790 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
23791 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
23792 OpenTracing filters.
23793
23794 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
23795 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
23796 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
23797 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
23798 filter must have its own scope defined.
23799
23800More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020023801of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023802
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200238039.7. Bandwidth limitation
23804--------------------------
23805
23806filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23807filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
23808filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23809filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
23810
23811 Arguments :
23812
23813 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
23814 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
23815
23816 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
23817 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23818 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23819 expressed in bytes.
23820
23821 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
23822 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
23823 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
23824 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23825
23826 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
23827 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
23828 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
23829
23830 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023831 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023832 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
23833 is expressed in milliseconds.
23834
23835 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
23836 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
23837 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
23838 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
23839 expressed in bytes.
23840
23841Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
23842speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
23843bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
23844used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
23845sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
23846other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
23847connections for a given client.
23848
23849The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
23850filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
23851definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
23852the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
23853compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
23854the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
23855for the cache filter.
23856
23857There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
23858default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050023859to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023860the table.
23861
23862In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
23863limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
23864forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
23865the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
23866used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
23867cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
23868level.
23869
23870The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
23871connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
23872of the same connection may have different limits.
23873
23874For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
23875defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
23876bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
23877only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
23878when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
23879
23880For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
23881incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
23882corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23883stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
23884used to limit outgoing data.
23885
23886Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
23887limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
23888to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
23889carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
23890it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
23891limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
23892experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
23893a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
23894start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
23895some experimentations.
23896
23897 Example:
23898 frontend http
23899 bind *:80
23900 mode http
23901
23902 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
23903 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
23904 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
23905
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050023906 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020023907 # independently of all other streams.
23908 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
23909
23910 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
23911 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
23912 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
23913 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
23914 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
23915 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
23916 ...
23917
23918 backend limit-by-src
23919 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
23920 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
23921
23922See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
23923 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
23924 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
23925 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010023926
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002392710. FastCGI applications
23928-------------------------
23929
23930HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
23931feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
23932the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
23933FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
23934servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
23935FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
23936backend.
23937
23938HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
23939application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
23940connection.
23941
2394210.1. Setup
23943-----------
23944
2394510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
23946--------------------------
23947
23948fcgi-app <name>
23949 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
23950 document root must be defined.
23951
23952acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
23953 Declare or complete an access list.
23954
23955 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
23956 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
23957 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
23958 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
23959 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
23960
23961docroot <path>
23962 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
23963 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
23964 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
23965
23966index <script-name>
23967 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
23968 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
23969 is an optional setting.
23970
23971 Example :
23972 index index.php
23973
23974log-stderr global
23975log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010023976 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020023977 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
23978
23979 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
23980 default STDERR messages are ignored.
23981
23982pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
23983 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
23984 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
23985 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
23986
23987 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
23988 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
23989 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
23990 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
23991
23992 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
23993 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
23994
23995path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010023996 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010023997 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
23998 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
23999 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24000 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24001 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24002 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24003 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024004
24005 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024006 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024007 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24008 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24009 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24010 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024011
24012 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024013 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24014 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024015
24016option get-values
24017no option get-values
24018 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24019
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024020 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024021 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24022
24023 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24024 application will accept.
24025
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024026 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24027 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024028
24029 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024030 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024031 option is disabled.
24032
24033 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24034 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24035 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24036 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24037 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24038 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24039
24040option keep-conn
24041no option keep-conn
24042 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24043 sending a response.
24044
24045 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24046 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24047
24048option max-reqs <reqs>
24049 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24050 accept.
24051
24052 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24053 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24054 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24055 to 1.
24056
24057option mpxs-conns
24058no option mpxs-conns
24059 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24060
24061 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24062 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24063
24064set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24065 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
24066 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
24067 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24068 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24069
24070 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24071 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24072 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24073
24074 Example :
24075 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24076 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24077
24078 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24079
24080
2408110.1.2. Proxy section
24082---------------------
24083
24084use-fcgi-app <name>
24085 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24086
24087 Arguments :
24088 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24089
24090 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24091 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24092 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24093 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24094 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24095
24096 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24097 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24098 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24099 application are evaluated.
24100
24101
2410210.1.3. Example
24103---------------
24104
24105 frontend front-http
24106 mode http
24107 bind *:80
24108 bind *:
24109
24110 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24111 default_backend back-static
24112
24113 backend back-static
24114 mode http
24115 server www A.B.C.D:80
24116
24117 backend back-dynamic
24118 mode http
24119 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24120 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24121
24122 fcgi-app php-fpm
24123 log-stderr global
24124 option keep-conn
24125
24126 docroot /var/www/my-app
24127 index index.php
24128 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24129
24130
2413110.2. Default parameters
24132------------------------
24133
24134A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24135the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024136script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024137applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24138
24139 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24140 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24141 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24142 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24143 | | |
24144 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24145 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24146 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24147 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24148 | | application. |
24149 | | |
24150 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24151 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24152 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24153 | | |
24154 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24155 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24156 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24157 | | the application's configuration. |
24158 | | |
24159 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24160 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24161 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24162 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24163 | | |
24164 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24165 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24166 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24167 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24168 | | be defined. |
24169 | | |
24170 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24171 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24172 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24173 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24174 | | is not set too. |
24175 | | |
24176 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24177 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24178 | | set. |
24179 | | |
24180 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24181 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24182 | | the request. |
24183 | | |
24184 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24185 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24186 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24187 | | |
24188 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24189 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24190 | | script to process the request. |
24191 | | |
24192 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24193 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24194 | | |
24195 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24196 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
24197 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
24198 | | |
24199 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24200 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
24201 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
24202 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
24203 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
24204 | | |
24205 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24206 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
24207 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
24208 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
24209 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
24210 | | side. |
24211 | | |
24212 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24213 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
24214 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
24215 | | connected to. |
24216 | | |
24217 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24218 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
24219 | | |
24220 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020024221 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
24222 | | current HAProxy version. |
24223 | | |
24224 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024225 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
24226 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
24227 | | |
24228 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24229
24230
2423110.3. Limitations
24232------------------
24233
24234The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
24235way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
24236during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
24237establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
24238application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
24239or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
24240message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
24241these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
24242and HTTP servers under the same backend.
24243
24244Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
24245request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
24246requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
24247
24248About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
24249into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
24250fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
24251"http-request" ones.
24252
24253Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
24254FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
24255processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
24256must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
24257here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010024258
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024259
2426011. Address formats
24261-------------------
24262
24263Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
24264address.
24265
24266This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
24267The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
24268of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
24269equivalent is '::'.
24270
24271Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
24272is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
24273
24274This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
24275family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
24276
24277Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
24278configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
24279use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
24280'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
24281
24282Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
24283socket type and the transport method.
24284
24285
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002428611.1. Address family prefixes
24287-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024288
24289'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
24290
24291'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
24292 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
24293 listening.
24294
24295'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
24296 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
24297 on the statement using this address, a port or
24298 a port range may or must be specified.
24299
24300'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24301 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
24302 using this address, a port or a port range
24303 may or must be specified.
24304
24305'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24306 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
24307 using this address, a port or a port range
24308 may or must be specified.
24309
24310'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
24311 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
24312 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
24313 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
24314 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
24315 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
24316
24317'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
24318 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
24319 start by slash '/'.
24320
24321
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002432211.2. Socket type prefixes
24323--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024324
24325Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
24326type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
24327this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
24328This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
24329but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
24330
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024331Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
24332use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
24333sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
24334known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
24335and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024336
24337If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
24338they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
24339report this to the maintainers.
24340
24341'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24342 to "stream"
24343
24344'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
24345 to "datagram".
24346
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024347'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
24348 method to "stream".
24349
24350
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024351
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002435211.3. Protocol prefixes
24353-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024354
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024355'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24356 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
24357 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24358 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24359 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024360 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24361 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024362
24363'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24364 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
24365 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
24366 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
24367 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024368 must be specified. It is equivalent to
24369 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010024370
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024371'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24372 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24373 socket type and transport method is forced to
24374 "stream". Depending on the statement using
24375 this address, a port or a port range can or
24376 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24377 of 'stream+ip@'.
24378
24379'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24380 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24381 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24382 statement using this address, a port or port
24383 range can or must be specified.
24384 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24385
24386'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24387 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24388 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
24389 statement using this address, a port or port
24390 range can or must be specified.
24391 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
24392
24393'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
24394 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
24395 socket type and transport method is forced to
24396 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
24397 this address, a port or a port range can or
24398 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
24399 of 'dgram+ip@'.
24400
24401'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24402 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
24403 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24404 the statement using this address, a port or
24405 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024406 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024407
24408'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24409 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
24410 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
24411 the statement using this address, a port or
24412 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010024413 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024414
24415'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24416 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
24417 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
24418
24419'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
24420 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
24421 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
24422
24423In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
24424QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
24425
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010024426/*
24427 * Local variables:
24428 * fill-column: 79
24429 * End:
24430 */